* gdb.texinfo (GDB/MI Variable Objects): Improve the
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
148 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
163 @value{GDBN}
164 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
165 how you can copy and share GDB
166 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
167 * Index:: Index
168 @end menu
169
170 @end ifnottex
171
172 @contents
173
174 @node Summary
175 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
176
177 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
178 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
179 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
180
181 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
182 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
183
184 @itemize @bullet
185 @item
186 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
187
188 @item
189 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
190
191 @item
192 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
193
194 @item
195 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
196 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
197 @end itemize
198
199 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
200 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
201 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
202
203 @cindex Modula-2
204 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
205 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
206
207 @cindex Pascal
208 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
209 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
210 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
211 syntax.
212
213 @cindex Fortran
214 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
215 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
216 underscore.
217
218 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
219 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
220
221 @menu
222 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
223 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
224 @end menu
225
226 @node Free Software
227 @unnumberedsec Free software
228
229 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
230 General Public License
231 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
232 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
233 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
234 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
235 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
236 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
237
238 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
239 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
240 from anyone else.
241
242 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
243
244 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
245 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
246 include with the free software. Many of our most important
247 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
248 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
249 when an important free software package does not come with a free
250 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
251 gaps today.
252
253 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
254 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
255 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
256 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
257 them from the free software world.
258
259 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
260 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
261 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
262 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
263 contract to make it non-free.
264
265 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
266 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
267 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
268 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
269 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
270 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
271 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
272
273 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
274 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
275 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
276 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
277
278 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
279 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
280 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
281 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
282 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
283 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
284 community.
285
286 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
287 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
288 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
289 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
290 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
291 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
292 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
293 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
294 of the manual.
295
296 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
297 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
298 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
299 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
300 manual to replace it.
301
302 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
303 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
304 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
305 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
306 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
307 the free software community.
308
309 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
310 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
311 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
312 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
313 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
314 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
315 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
316 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
317 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
318
319 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
320 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
321 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
322 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
323 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
324 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
325 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
326 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
327
328 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
329 published by other publishers, at
330 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
331
332 @node Contributors
333 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
334
335 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
336 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
337 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
338 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
339 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
340 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
341 blow-by-blow account.
342
343 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
344
345 @quotation
346 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
347 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
348 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
349 @end quotation
350
351 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
352 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
353 releases:
354 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
355 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
356 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
357 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
358 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
359 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
360 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
361 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
362 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
363
364 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
365 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
366
367 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
368 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
369 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
370 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
371 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
372
373 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
374 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
375 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
376
377 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
378 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
379
380 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
381
382 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
383 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
384 support.
385 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
386 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
387 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
388 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
389 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
390 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
391 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
392 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
393 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
394 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
395 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
396 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
397 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
398 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
399 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
400 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
401
402 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
403
404 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
405 libraries.
406
407 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
408 about several machine instruction sets.
409
410 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
411 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
412 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
413 and RDI targets, respectively.
414
415 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
416 command-line editing and command history.
417
418 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
419 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
420
421 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
422 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
423 symbols.
424
425 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
426 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
427
428 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
429
430 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
431 processors.
432
433 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
434
435 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
436
437 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
438
439 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
440 watchpoints.
441
442 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
443
444 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
445
446 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
447 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
448
449 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
450 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
451 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
452 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
453 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
454 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
455 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
456
457 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
458 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
459
460 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
461 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
462 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
463 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
464 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
465 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
466 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
467 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
468 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
469 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
470 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
471 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
472 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
473 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
474 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
475
476 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
477 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
478
479 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
480 Hat.
481
482 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
483 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
484 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
485 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
486 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
487 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
488
489 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
490 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
491 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
492 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
493 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
494 trad unwinders. The architecture specific changes, each involving a
495 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
496 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
497 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
498 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
499 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
500 Weigand.
501
502 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
503 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
504 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
505 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
506
507 @node Sample Session
508 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
509
510 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
511 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
512 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
513
514 @iftex
515 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
516 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
517 @end iftex
518
519 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
520 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
521
522 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
523 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
524 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
525 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
526 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
527 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
528 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
529 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
530 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
531
532 @smallexample
533 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
534 $ @b{./m4}
535 @b{define(foo,0000)}
536
537 @b{foo}
538 0000
539 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
540
541 @b{bar}
542 0000
543 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
544
545 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
546 @b{baz}
547 @b{Ctrl-d}
548 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
549 @end smallexample
550
551 @noindent
552 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
553
554 @smallexample
555 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
556 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
557 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
558 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
559 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
560 the conditions.
561 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
562 for details.
563
564 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
565 (@value{GDBP})
566 @end smallexample
567
568 @noindent
569 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
570 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
571 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
572 that examples fit in this manual.
573
574 @smallexample
575 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
576 @end smallexample
577
578 @noindent
579 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
580 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
581 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
582 @code{break} command.
583
584 @smallexample
585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
586 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
587 @end smallexample
588
589 @noindent
590 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
591 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
592 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
593
594 @smallexample
595 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
596 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
597 @b{define(foo,0000)}
598
599 @b{foo}
600 0000
601 @end smallexample
602
603 @noindent
604 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
605 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
606 context where it stops.
607
608 @smallexample
609 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
610
611 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
612 at builtin.c:879
613 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
614 @end smallexample
615
616 @noindent
617 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
618 the next line of the current function.
619
620 @smallexample
621 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
622 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
623 : nil,
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
628 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
629 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
630 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
631
632 @smallexample
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
634 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
635 at input.c:530
636 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
637 @end smallexample
638
639 @noindent
640 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
641 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
642 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
643 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
644 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
645 stack frame for each active subroutine.
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
649 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
650 at input.c:530
651 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
652 at builtin.c:882
653 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
654 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
655 at macro.c:71
656 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
657 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
658 @end smallexample
659
660 @noindent
661 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
662 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
663 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
664
665 @smallexample
666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
667 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
669 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
670 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
671 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
672 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
673 : xstrdup(rq);
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
676 @end smallexample
677
678 @noindent
679 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
680 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
681 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
682 (@code{print}) to see their values.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
686 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
688 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
689 @end smallexample
690
691 @noindent
692 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
693 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
694 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
695
696 @smallexample
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
698 533 xfree(rquote);
699 534
700 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
701 : xstrdup (lq);
702 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
703 : xstrdup (rq);
704 537
705 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
706 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
707 540 @}
708 541
709 542 void
710 @end smallexample
711
712 @noindent
713 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
714 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
715
716 @smallexample
717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
718 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
720 540 @}
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
722 $3 = 9
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
724 $4 = 7
725 @end smallexample
726
727 @noindent
728 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
729 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
730 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
731 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
732 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
733 assignments.
734
735 @smallexample
736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
737 $5 = 7
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
739 $6 = 9
740 @end smallexample
741
742 @noindent
743 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
744 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
745 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
746 example that caused trouble initially:
747
748 @smallexample
749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
750 Continuing.
751
752 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
753
754 baz
755 0000
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @noindent
759 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
760 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
761 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
762
763 @smallexample
764 @b{Ctrl-d}
765 Program exited normally.
766 @end smallexample
767
768 @noindent
769 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
770 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
771 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
772
773 @smallexample
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
775 @end smallexample
776
777 @node Invocation
778 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
779
780 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
781 The essentials are:
782 @itemize @bullet
783 @item
784 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
785 @item
786 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
787 @end itemize
788
789 @menu
790 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
791 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
792 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
793 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
794 @end menu
795
796 @node Invoking GDB
797 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
798
799 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
800 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
801
802 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
803 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
804
805 The command-line options described here are designed
806 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
807 options may effectively be unavailable.
808
809 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
810 specifying an executable program:
811
812 @smallexample
813 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
814 @end smallexample
815
816 @noindent
817 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
818 specified:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
825 to debug a running process:
826
827 @smallexample
828 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
829 @end smallexample
830
831 @noindent
832 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
833 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
834
835 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
836 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
837 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
838 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
839 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
840
841 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
842 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
843 option processing.
844 @smallexample
845 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
846 @end smallexample
847 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
848 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
849
850 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
851 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
852
853 @smallexample
854 @value{GDBP} -silent
855 @end smallexample
856
857 @noindent
858 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
859 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
860
861 @noindent
862 Type
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} -help
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
870 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
871
872 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
873 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
874 @samp{-x} option is used.
875
876
877 @menu
878 * File Options:: Choosing files
879 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
880 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
881 @end menu
882
883 @node File Options
884 @subsection Choosing files
885
886 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
887 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
888 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
889 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
890 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
891 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
892 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
893 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
894 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
895 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
896 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
897 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
898 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
899
900 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
901 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
902 argument and ignore it.
903
904 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
905 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
906 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
907 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
908 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
909
910 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
911 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
912 @c it.
913
914 @table @code
915 @item -symbols @var{file}
916 @itemx -s @var{file}
917 @cindex @code{--symbols}
918 @cindex @code{-s}
919 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
920
921 @item -exec @var{file}
922 @itemx -e @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--exec}
924 @cindex @code{-e}
925 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
926 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
927
928 @item -se @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--se}
930 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
931 file.
932
933 @item -core @var{file}
934 @itemx -c @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--core}
936 @cindex @code{-c}
937 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
938
939 @item -c @var{number}
940 @item -pid @var{number}
941 @itemx -p @var{number}
942 @cindex @code{--pid}
943 @cindex @code{-p}
944 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
945 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
946 file named @var{number}.
947
948 @item -command @var{file}
949 @itemx -x @var{file}
950 @cindex @code{--command}
951 @cindex @code{-x}
952 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
953 Files,, Command files}.
954
955 @item -eval-command @var{command}
956 @itemx -ex @var{command}
957 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
958 @cindex @code{-ex}
959 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
960
961 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
962 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
963
964 @smallexample
965 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
966 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
967 @end smallexample
968
969 @item -directory @var{directory}
970 @itemx -d @var{directory}
971 @cindex @code{--directory}
972 @cindex @code{-d}
973 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
974
975 @item -r
976 @itemx -readnow
977 @cindex @code{--readnow}
978 @cindex @code{-r}
979 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
980 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
981 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
982
983 @end table
984
985 @node Mode Options
986 @subsection Choosing modes
987
988 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
989 batch mode or quiet mode.
990
991 @table @code
992 @item -nx
993 @itemx -n
994 @cindex @code{--nx}
995 @cindex @code{-n}
996 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
997 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
998 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
999 files}.
1000
1001 @item -quiet
1002 @itemx -silent
1003 @itemx -q
1004 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1005 @cindex @code{--silent}
1006 @cindex @code{-q}
1007 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1008 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1009
1010 @item -batch
1011 @cindex @code{--batch}
1012 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1013 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1014 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1015 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1016 in the command files.
1017
1018 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1019 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1020 make this more useful, the message
1021
1022 @smallexample
1023 Program exited normally.
1024 @end smallexample
1025
1026 @noindent
1027 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1028 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1029 mode.
1030
1031 @item -batch-silent
1032 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1033 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1034 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1035 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1036 for an interactive session.
1037
1038 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1039 messages, for example.
1040
1041 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1042 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1043
1044 @item -return-child-result
1045 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1046 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1047 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1048
1049 @itemize @bullet
1050 @item
1051 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1052 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1053 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1054 @item
1055 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1056 @item
1057 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1058 the exit code will be -1.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1062 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1063 interface.
1064
1065 @item -nowindows
1066 @itemx -nw
1067 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1068 @cindex @code{-nw}
1069 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1070 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1071 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1072
1073 @item -windows
1074 @itemx -w
1075 @cindex @code{--windows}
1076 @cindex @code{-w}
1077 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1078 used if possible.
1079
1080 @item -cd @var{directory}
1081 @cindex @code{--cd}
1082 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1083 instead of the current directory.
1084
1085 @item -fullname
1086 @itemx -f
1087 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1088 @cindex @code{-f}
1089 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1090 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1091 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1092 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1093 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1094 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1095 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1096 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1097 frame.
1098
1099 @item -epoch
1100 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1101 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1102 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1103 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1104 separate window.
1105
1106 @item -annotate @var{level}
1107 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1108 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1109 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1110 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1111 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1112 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1113 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1114 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1115 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1116
1117 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1118 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1119
1120 @item --args
1121 @cindex @code{--args}
1122 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1123 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1124 This option stops option processing.
1125
1126 @item -baud @var{bps}
1127 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1128 @cindex @code{--baud}
1129 @cindex @code{-b}
1130 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1131 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1132
1133 @item -l @var{timeout}
1134 @cindex @code{-l}
1135 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1136 for remote debugging.
1137
1138 @item -tty @var{device}
1139 @itemx -t @var{device}
1140 @cindex @code{--tty}
1141 @cindex @code{-t}
1142 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1143 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1144
1145 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1146 @item -tui
1147 @cindex @code{--tui}
1148 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1149 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1150 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1151 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1152 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1153 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1154 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1155
1156 @c @item -xdb
1157 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1158 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1159 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1160 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1161 @c systems.
1162
1163 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1164 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1165 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1166 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1167 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1168 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1169
1170 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1171 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1172 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1173 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1174 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1175 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1176
1177 @item -write
1178 @cindex @code{--write}
1179 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1180 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1181 (@pxref{Patching}).
1182
1183 @item -statistics
1184 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1185 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1186 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1187
1188 @item -version
1189 @cindex @code{--version}
1190 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1191 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1192
1193 @end table
1194
1195 @node Startup
1196 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1197 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1198
1199 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1200
1201 @enumerate
1202 @item
1203 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1204 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1205
1206 @item
1207 @cindex init file
1208 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1209 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1210 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1211 that file.
1212
1213 @item
1214 Processes command line options and operands.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1218 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1219 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1220 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1221 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1222 @value{GDBN}.
1223
1224 @item
1225 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1226 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1227
1228 @item
1229 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1230 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1231 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1232 @end enumerate
1233
1234 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1235 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1236 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1237 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1238 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1239 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1240
1241 @cindex init file name
1242 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1243 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1244 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1245 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1246 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1247 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1248 environments with special init file names:
1249
1250 @itemize @bullet
1251 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1252 @item
1253 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1254 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1255 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1256 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1257 the file to the standard name.
1258
1259 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1260 @item
1261 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1262
1263 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1264 @item
1265 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1266
1267 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1268 @item
1269 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1270
1271 @item
1272 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1273 @end itemize
1274
1275
1276 @node Quitting GDB
1277 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1278 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1279 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1280
1281 @table @code
1282 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1283 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1284 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1285 @itemx q
1286 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1287 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1288 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1289 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1290 error code.
1291 @end table
1292
1293 @cindex interrupt
1294 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1295 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1296 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1297 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1298 until a time when it is safe.
1299
1300 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1301 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1302 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1303
1304 @node Shell Commands
1305 @section Shell commands
1306
1307 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1308 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1309 just use the @code{shell} command.
1310
1311 @table @code
1312 @kindex shell
1313 @cindex shell escape
1314 @item shell @var{command string}
1315 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1316 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1317 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1318 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1319 @end table
1320
1321 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1322 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1323 @value{GDBN}:
1324
1325 @table @code
1326 @kindex make
1327 @cindex calling make
1328 @item make @var{make-args}
1329 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1330 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1331 @end table
1332
1333 @node Logging output
1334 @section Logging output
1335 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1336 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1337
1338 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1339 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1340
1341 @table @code
1342 @kindex set logging
1343 @item set logging on
1344 Enable logging.
1345 @item set logging off
1346 Disable logging.
1347 @cindex logging file name
1348 @item set logging file @var{file}
1349 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1350 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1351 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1352 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1353 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1354 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1355 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1356 @kindex show logging
1357 @item show logging
1358 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1359 @end table
1360
1361 @node Commands
1362 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1363
1364 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1365 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1366 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1367 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1368 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1369
1370 @menu
1371 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1372 * Completion:: Command completion
1373 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1374 @end menu
1375
1376 @node Command Syntax
1377 @section Command syntax
1378
1379 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1380 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1381 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1382 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1383 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1384 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1385
1386 @cindex abbreviation
1387 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1388 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1389 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1390 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1391 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1392 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1393 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1394
1395 @cindex repeating commands
1396 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1397 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1398 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1399 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1400 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1401 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1402 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1403
1404 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1405 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1406 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1407
1408 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1409 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1410 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1411 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1412 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1413
1414 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1415 @cindex comment
1416 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1417 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1418 Files,,Command files}).
1419
1420 @cindex repeating command sequences
1421 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1422 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1423 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1424 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1425 for editing.
1426
1427 @node Completion
1428 @section Command completion
1429
1430 @cindex completion
1431 @cindex word completion
1432 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1433 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1434 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1435 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1436
1437 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1438 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1439 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1440 enter it). For example, if you type
1441
1442 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1443 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1444 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1445 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1446 @smallexample
1447 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1448 @end smallexample
1449
1450 @noindent
1451 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1452 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1453
1454 @smallexample
1455 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1456 @end smallexample
1457
1458 @noindent
1459 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1460 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1461 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1462 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1463 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1464 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1465
1466 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1467 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1468 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1469 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1470 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1471 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1472 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1473 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1474 example:
1475
1476 @smallexample
1477 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1478 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1479 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1480 make_abs_section make_function_type
1481 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1482 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1483 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1484 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1485 @end smallexample
1486
1487 @noindent
1488 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1489 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1490 command.
1491
1492 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1493 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1494 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1495 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1496 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1497
1498 @cindex quotes in commands
1499 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1500 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1501 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1502 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1503 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1504 @value{GDBN} commands.
1505
1506 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1507 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1508 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1509 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1510 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1511 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1512 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1513 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1514 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1515 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1516 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1517
1518 @smallexample
1519 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1520 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1521 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1522 @end smallexample
1523
1524 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1525 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1526 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1527 place:
1528
1529 @smallexample
1530 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1531 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1532 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1533 @end smallexample
1534
1535 @noindent
1536 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1537 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1538 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1539
1540 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1541 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1542 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1543 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1544
1545
1546 @node Help
1547 @section Getting help
1548 @cindex online documentation
1549 @kindex help
1550
1551 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1552 using the command @code{help}.
1553
1554 @table @code
1555 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1556 @item help
1557 @itemx h
1558 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1559 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1560
1561 @smallexample
1562 (@value{GDBP}) help
1563 List of classes of commands:
1564
1565 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1566 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1567 data -- Examining data
1568 files -- Specifying and examining files
1569 internals -- Maintenance commands
1570 obscure -- Obscure features
1571 running -- Running the program
1572 stack -- Examining the stack
1573 status -- Status inquiries
1574 support -- Support facilities
1575 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1576 stopping the program
1577 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1578
1579 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1580 commands in that class.
1581 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1582 documentation.
1583 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1584 (@value{GDBP})
1585 @end smallexample
1586 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1587
1588 @item help @var{class}
1589 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1590 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1591 help display for the class @code{status}:
1592
1593 @smallexample
1594 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1595 Status inquiries.
1596
1597 List of commands:
1598
1599 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1600 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1601 info -- Generic command for showing things
1602 about the program being debugged
1603 show -- Generic command for showing things
1604 about the debugger
1605
1606 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1607 documentation.
1608 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1609 (@value{GDBP})
1610 @end smallexample
1611
1612 @item help @var{command}
1613 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1614 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1615
1616 @kindex apropos
1617 @item apropos @var{args}
1618 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1619 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1620 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1621
1622 @smallexample
1623 apropos reload
1624 @end smallexample
1625
1626 @noindent
1627 results in:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @c @group
1631 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1632 multiple times in one run
1633 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1634 multiple times in one run
1635 @c @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @kindex complete
1639 @item complete @var{args}
1640 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1641 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1642 command you want completed. For example:
1643
1644 @smallexample
1645 complete i
1646 @end smallexample
1647
1648 @noindent results in:
1649
1650 @smallexample
1651 @group
1652 if
1653 ignore
1654 info
1655 inspect
1656 @end group
1657 @end smallexample
1658
1659 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1660 @end table
1661
1662 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1663 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1664 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1665 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1666 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1667 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1668
1669 @c @group
1670 @table @code
1671 @kindex info
1672 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1673 @item info
1674 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1675 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1676 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1677 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1678 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1679 @w{@code{help info}}.
1680
1681 @kindex set
1682 @item set
1683 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1684 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1685 @code{set prompt $}.
1686
1687 @kindex show
1688 @item show
1689 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1690 @value{GDBN} itself.
1691 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1692 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1693 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1694 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1695
1696 @kindex info set
1697 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1698 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1699 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1700 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1701 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1702 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1703 @end table
1704 @c @end group
1705
1706 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1707 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1708
1709 @table @code
1710 @kindex show version
1711 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1712 @item show version
1713 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1714 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1715 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1716 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1717 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1718 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1719 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1720 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1721 @value{GDBN}.
1722
1723 @kindex show copying
1724 @kindex info copying
1725 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1726 @item show copying
1727 @itemx info copying
1728 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1729
1730 @kindex show warranty
1731 @kindex info warranty
1732 @item show warranty
1733 @itemx info warranty
1734 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1735 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1736
1737 @end table
1738
1739 @node Running
1740 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1741
1742 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1743 debugging information when you compile it.
1744
1745 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1746 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1747 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1748 kill a child process.
1749
1750 @menu
1751 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1752 * Starting:: Starting your program
1753 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1754 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1755
1756 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1757 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1758 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1759 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1760
1761 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1762 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1763 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1764 @end menu
1765
1766 @node Compilation
1767 @section Compiling for debugging
1768
1769 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1770 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1771 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1772 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1773 and addresses in the executable code.
1774
1775 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1776 the compiler.
1777
1778 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1779 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1780 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1781 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1782 executables containing debugging information.
1783
1784 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1785 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1786 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1787 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1788 in pushing your luck.
1789
1790 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1791 @cindex debugging optimized code
1792 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1793 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1794 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1795 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1796 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1797 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1798
1799 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1800 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1801 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1802 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1803 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1804
1805 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1806 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1807 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1808
1809 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1810 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1811 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1812 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1813 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1814 provides macro information if you specify the options
1815 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1816 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1817 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1818 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1819 @option{-g} alone.
1820
1821 @need 2000
1822 @node Starting
1823 @section Starting your program
1824 @cindex starting
1825 @cindex running
1826
1827 @table @code
1828 @kindex run
1829 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1830 @item run
1831 @itemx r
1832 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1833 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1834 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1835 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1836 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1837
1838 @end table
1839
1840 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1841 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1842 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1843 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1844
1845 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1846 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1847 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1848 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1849 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1850 divided into four categories:
1851
1852 @table @asis
1853 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1854 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1855 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1856 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1857 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1858 the arguments.
1859 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1860 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1861 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1862
1863 @item The @emph{environment.}
1864 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1865 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1866 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1867 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1868
1869 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1870 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1871 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1872 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1873
1874 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1875 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1876 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1877 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1878 set a different device for your program.
1879 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1880
1881 @cindex pipes
1882 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1883 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1884 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1885 wrong program.
1886 @end table
1887
1888 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1889 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1890 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1891 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1892 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1893
1894 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1895 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1896 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1897 your current breakpoints.
1898
1899 @table @code
1900 @kindex start
1901 @item start
1902 @cindex run to main procedure
1903 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1904 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1905 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1906 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1907 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1908 procedure, depending on the language used.
1909
1910 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1911 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1912 the @samp{run} command.
1913
1914 @cindex elaboration phase
1915 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1916 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1917 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1918 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1919 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1920 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1921 will remain to halt execution.
1922
1923 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1924 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1925 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1926 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1927 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1928
1929 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1930 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1931 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1932 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1933 elaboration code before running your program.
1934 @end table
1935
1936 @node Arguments
1937 @section Your program's arguments
1938
1939 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1940 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1941 @code{run} command.
1942 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1943 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1944 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1945 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1946 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1947
1948 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1949 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1950 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1951 the program, not by the shell.
1952
1953 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1954 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1955
1956 @table @code
1957 @kindex set args
1958 @item set args
1959 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1960 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1961 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1962 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1963 it again without arguments.
1964
1965 @kindex show args
1966 @item show args
1967 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1968 @end table
1969
1970 @node Environment
1971 @section Your program's environment
1972
1973 @cindex environment (of your program)
1974 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1975 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1976 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1977 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1978 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1979 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1980 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1981
1982 @table @code
1983 @kindex path
1984 @item path @var{directory}
1985 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1986 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1987 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1988 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1989 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1990 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1991 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1992
1993 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1994 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1995 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1996 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1997 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1998 @var{directory} to the search path.
1999 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2000 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2001
2002 @kindex show paths
2003 @item show paths
2004 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2005 environment variable).
2006
2007 @kindex show environment
2008 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2009 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2010 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2011 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2012 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2013
2014 @kindex set environment
2015 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2016 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2017 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2018 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2019 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2020 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2021 null value.
2022 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2023 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2024
2025 For example, this command:
2026
2027 @smallexample
2028 set env USER = foo
2029 @end smallexample
2030
2031 @noindent
2032 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2033 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2034 are not actually required.)
2035
2036 @kindex unset environment
2037 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2038 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2039 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2040 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2041 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2042 @end table
2043
2044 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2045 the shell indicated
2046 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2047 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2048 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2049 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2050 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2051 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2052 @file{.profile}.
2053
2054 @node Working Directory
2055 @section Your program's working directory
2056
2057 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2058 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2059 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2060 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2061 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2062 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2063
2064 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2065 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2066 specify files}.
2067
2068 @table @code
2069 @kindex cd
2070 @cindex change working directory
2071 @item cd @var{directory}
2072 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2073
2074 @kindex pwd
2075 @item pwd
2076 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2077 @end table
2078
2079 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2080 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2081 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2082 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2083 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2084 current working directory of the debuggee.
2085
2086 @node Input/Output
2087 @section Your program's input and output
2088
2089 @cindex redirection
2090 @cindex i/o
2091 @cindex terminal
2092 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2093 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2094 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2095 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2096 running your program.
2097
2098 @table @code
2099 @kindex info terminal
2100 @item info terminal
2101 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2102 program is using.
2103 @end table
2104
2105 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2106 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2107
2108 @smallexample
2109 run > outfile
2110 @end smallexample
2111
2112 @noindent
2113 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2114
2115 @kindex tty
2116 @cindex controlling terminal
2117 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2118 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2119 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2120 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2121 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2122
2123 @smallexample
2124 tty /dev/ttyb
2125 @end smallexample
2126
2127 @noindent
2128 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2129 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2130 that as their controlling terminal.
2131
2132 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2133 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2134 terminal.
2135
2136 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2137 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2138 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2139 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2140
2141 @cindex inferior tty
2142 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2143 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2144 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2145 program.
2146
2147 @table @code
2148 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2149 @kindex set inferior-tty
2150 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2151
2152 @item show inferior-tty
2153 @kindex show inferior-tty
2154 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2155 @end table
2156
2157 @node Attach
2158 @section Debugging an already-running process
2159 @kindex attach
2160 @cindex attach
2161
2162 @table @code
2163 @item attach @var{process-id}
2164 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2165 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2166 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2167 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2168 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2169
2170 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2171 executing the command.
2172 @end table
2173
2174 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2175 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2176 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2177 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2178
2179 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2180 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2181 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2182 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2183 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2184 Specify Files}.
2185
2186 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2187 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2188 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2189 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2190 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2191 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2192 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2193
2194 @table @code
2195 @kindex detach
2196 @item detach
2197 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2198 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2199 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2200 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2201 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2202 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2203 executing the command.
2204 @end table
2205
2206 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2207 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2208 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2209 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2210 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2211 messages}).
2212
2213 @node Kill Process
2214 @section Killing the child process
2215
2216 @table @code
2217 @kindex kill
2218 @item kill
2219 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2220 @end table
2221
2222 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2223 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2224 is running.
2225
2226 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2227 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2228 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2229 outside the debugger.
2230
2231 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2232 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2233 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2234 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2235 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2236 breakpoint settings).
2237
2238 @node Threads
2239 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2240
2241 @cindex threads of execution
2242 @cindex multiple threads
2243 @cindex switching threads
2244 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2245 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2246 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2247 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2248 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2249 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2250 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2251
2252 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2253 programs:
2254
2255 @itemize @bullet
2256 @item automatic notification of new threads
2257 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2258 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2259 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2260 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2261 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2262 @end itemize
2263
2264 @quotation
2265 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2266 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2267 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2268 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2269 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2270 like this:
2271
2272 @smallexample
2273 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2274 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2275 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2276 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2277 @end smallexample
2278 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2279 @c doesn't support threads"?
2280 @end quotation
2281
2282 @cindex focus of debugging
2283 @cindex current thread
2284 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2285 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2286 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2287 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2288 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2289
2290 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2291 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2292 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2293 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2294 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2295 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2296 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2297 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2298 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2299 LynxOS, you might see
2300
2301 @smallexample
2302 [New process 35 thread 27]
2303 @end smallexample
2304
2305 @noindent
2306 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2307 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2308 further qualifier.
2309
2310 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2311 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2312 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2313 @c program?
2314 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2315 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2316 @c threads ab initio?
2317
2318 @cindex thread number
2319 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2320 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2321 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2322
2323 @table @code
2324 @kindex info threads
2325 @item info threads
2326 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2327 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2328
2329 @enumerate
2330 @item
2331 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2332
2333 @item
2334 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2335
2336 @item
2337 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2338 @end enumerate
2339
2340 @noindent
2341 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2342 indicates the current thread.
2343
2344 For example,
2345 @end table
2346 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2347
2348 @smallexample
2349 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2350 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2351 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2352 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2353 at threadtest.c:68
2354 @end smallexample
2355
2356 On HP-UX systems:
2357
2358 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2359 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2360 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2361 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2362 thread in your program.
2363
2364 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2365 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2366 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2367 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2368 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2369 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2370 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2371 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2372 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2373 HP-UX, you see
2374
2375 @smallexample
2376 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2377 @end smallexample
2378
2379 @noindent
2380 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2381
2382 @table @code
2383 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2384 @item info threads
2385 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2386 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2387
2388 @enumerate
2389 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2390
2391 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2392
2393 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2394 @end enumerate
2395
2396 @noindent
2397 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2398 indicates the current thread.
2399
2400 For example,
2401 @end table
2402 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2403
2404 @smallexample
2405 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2406 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2407 at quicksort.c:137
2408 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2409 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2410 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2411 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2412 @end smallexample
2413
2414 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2415 Solaris-specific command:
2416
2417 @table @code
2418 @item maint info sol-threads
2419 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2420 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2421 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2422 @end table
2423
2424 @table @code
2425 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2426 @item thread @var{threadno}
2427 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2428 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2429 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2430 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2431 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2432
2433 @smallexample
2434 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2435 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2436 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2437 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2438 @end smallexample
2439
2440 @noindent
2441 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2442 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2443 threads.
2444
2445 @kindex thread apply
2446 @cindex apply command to several threads
2447 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2448 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2449 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2450 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2451 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2452 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2453 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2454 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2455 @end table
2456
2457 @cindex automatic thread selection
2458 @cindex switching threads automatically
2459 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2460 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2461 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2462 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2463 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2464 thread.
2465
2466 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2467 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2468 programs with multiple threads.
2469
2470 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2471 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2472
2473 @node Processes
2474 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2475
2476 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2477 @cindex multiple processes
2478 @cindex processes, multiple
2479 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2480 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2481 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2482 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2483 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2484 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2485 will cause it to terminate.
2486
2487 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2488 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2489 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2490 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2491 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2492 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2493 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2494 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2495 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2496 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2497
2498 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2499 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2500 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2501 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2502
2503 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2504 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2505
2506 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2507 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2508
2509 @table @code
2510 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2511 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2512 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2513 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2514 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item parent
2518 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2519 unimpeded. This is the default.
2520
2521 @item child
2522 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2523 unimpeded.
2524
2525 @end table
2526
2527 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2528 @item show follow-fork-mode
2529 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2530 @end table
2531
2532 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2533 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2534 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2535
2536 @table @code
2537 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2538 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2539 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2540 retain debugger control over them both.
2541
2542 @table @code
2543 @item on
2544 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2545 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2546 independently. This is the default.
2547
2548 @item off
2549 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2550 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2551 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2552 is held suspended.
2553
2554 @end table
2555
2556 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2557 @item show detach-on-follow
2558 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2559 @end table
2560
2561 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2562 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2563 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2564 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2565 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2566
2567 @table @code
2568 @kindex info forks
2569 @item info forks
2570 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2571 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2572 position (program counter) of the process.
2573
2574
2575 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2576 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2577 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2578 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2579 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2580
2581 @end table
2582
2583 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2584 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2585 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2586 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2587
2588 @table @code
2589 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2590 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2591 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2592 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2593 allowed to run independently.
2594
2595 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2596 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2597 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2598 and remove it from the fork list.
2599
2600 @end table
2601
2602 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2603 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2604 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2605 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2606 the child process's @code{main}.
2607
2608 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2609 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2610
2611 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2612 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2613 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2614 argument.
2615
2616 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2617 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2618 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2619
2620 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2621 @section Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2622
2623 @cindex checkpoint
2624 @cindex restart
2625 @cindex bookmark
2626 @cindex snapshot of a process
2627 @cindex rewind program state
2628
2629 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2630 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2631 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2632 later.
2633
2634 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2635 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2636 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2637 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2638 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2639
2640 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2641 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2642 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2643 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2644 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2645 start again from there.
2646
2647 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2648 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2649
2650 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2651
2652 @table @code
2653 @kindex checkpoint
2654 @item checkpoint
2655 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2656 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2657 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2658
2659 @kindex info checkpoints
2660 @item info checkpoints
2661 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2662 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2663 listed:
2664
2665 @table @code
2666 @item Checkpoint ID
2667 @item Process ID
2668 @item Code Address
2669 @item Source line, or label
2670 @end table
2671
2672 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2673 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2674 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2675 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2676 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2677 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2678 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2679
2680 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2681 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2682 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2683 the debugger.
2684
2685 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2686 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2687 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2688
2689 @end table
2690
2691 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2692 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2693 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2694 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2695 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2696 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2697 previously read data can be read again.
2698
2699 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2700 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2701 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2702 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2703 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2704 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2705
2706 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2707 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2708 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2709 different execution path this time.
2710
2711 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2712 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2713 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2714 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2715 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2716 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2717 potentially pose a problem.
2718
2719 @subsection A non-obvious benefit of using checkpoints
2720
2721 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2722 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2723 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2724 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2725 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2726 next.
2727
2728 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2729 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2730 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2731 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2732 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2733
2734 @node Stopping
2735 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2736
2737 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2738 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2739 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2740
2741 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2742 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2743 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2744 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2745 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2746 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2747 explicitly request this information at any time.
2748
2749 @table @code
2750 @kindex info program
2751 @item info program
2752 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2753 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2754 @end table
2755
2756 @menu
2757 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2758 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2759 * Signals:: Signals
2760 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2761 @end menu
2762
2763 @node Breakpoints
2764 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2765
2766 @cindex breakpoints
2767 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2768 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2769 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2770 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2771 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2772 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2773 program.
2774
2775 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2776 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2777 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2778 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2779 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2780 call).
2781
2782 @cindex watchpoints
2783 @cindex data breakpoints
2784 @cindex memory tracing
2785 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2786 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2787 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2788 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2789 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2790 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2791 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2792 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting watchpoints}), but aside
2793 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2794 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2795 same commands.
2796
2797 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2798 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2799 Automatic display}.
2800
2801 @cindex catchpoints
2802 @cindex breakpoint on events
2803 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2804 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2805 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2806 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2807 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2808 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2809 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2810
2811 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2812 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2813 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2814 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2815 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2816 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2817 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2818 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2819 enable it again.
2820
2821 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2822 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2823 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2824 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2825 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2826 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2827 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2828
2829 @menu
2830 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2831 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2832 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2833 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2834 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2835 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2836 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2837 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2838 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2839 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2840 @end menu
2841
2842 @node Set Breaks
2843 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2844
2845 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2846 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2847 @c
2848 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2849
2850 @kindex break
2851 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2852 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2853 @cindex latest breakpoint
2854 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2855 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2856 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2857 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2858 convenience variables.
2859
2860 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2861
2862 @table @code
2863 @item break @var{function}
2864 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2865 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2866 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2867 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2868
2869 @item break +@var{offset}
2870 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2871 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2872 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2873 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2874
2875 @item break @var{linenum}
2876 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2877 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2878 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2879 code on that line.
2880
2881 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2882 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2883
2884 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2885 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2886 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2887 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2888 functions.
2889
2890 @item break *@var{address}
2891 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2892 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2893 information or source files.
2894
2895 @item break
2896 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2897 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2898 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2899 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2900 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2901 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2902 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2903 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2904 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2905 inside loops.
2906
2907 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2908 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2909 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2910 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2911 existed when your program stopped.
2912
2913 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2914 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2915 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2916 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2917 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2918 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2919 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2920
2921 @kindex tbreak
2922 @item tbreak @var{args}
2923 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2924 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2925 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2926 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2927
2928 @kindex hbreak
2929 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2930 @item hbreak @var{args}
2931 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2932 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2933 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2934 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2935 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2936 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2937 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2938 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2939 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2940 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2941 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2942 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2943 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2944 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2945 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2946 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2947 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2948
2949
2950 @kindex thbreak
2951 @item thbreak @var{args}
2952 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2953 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2954 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2955 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2956 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2957 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2958 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2959 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2960
2961 @kindex rbreak
2962 @cindex regular expression
2963 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2964 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2965 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2966 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2967 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2968 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2969 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2970 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2971 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2972
2973 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2974 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2975 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2976 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2977 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2978 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2979
2980 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2981 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2982 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2983 classes.
2984
2985 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2986 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2987 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2988
2989 @smallexample
2990 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2991 @end smallexample
2992
2993 @kindex info breakpoints
2994 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2995 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2996 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2997 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2998 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2999 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3000 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3001 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3002
3003 @table @emph
3004 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3005 @item Type
3006 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3007 @item Disposition
3008 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3009 @item Enabled or Disabled
3010 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3011 that are not enabled.
3012 @item Address
3013 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
3014 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
3015 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
3016 @item What
3017 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3018 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3019 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3020 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3021 @end table
3022
3023 @noindent
3024 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3025 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3026 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3027 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3028 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3029 valid location.
3030
3031 @noindent
3032 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3033 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3034 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3035 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3036 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
3037
3038 @noindent
3039 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3040 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3041 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3042 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3043 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3044 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3045 @end table
3046
3047 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3048 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3049 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3050 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3051
3052 @cindex pending breakpoints
3053 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3054 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3055 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3056 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3057 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3058 gets loaded.
3059
3060 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3061 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3062 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3063 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3064 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3065 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3066
3067 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3068 breakpoint support:
3069
3070 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3071 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3072 @table @code
3073 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3074 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3075 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3076
3077 @item set breakpoint pending on
3078 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3079 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3080
3081 @item set breakpoint pending off
3082 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3083 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3084 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3085
3086 @item show breakpoint pending
3087 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3088 @end table
3089
3090 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3091 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3092 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3093 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3094 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3095 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3096 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3097 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3098 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3099 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3100 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3101 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3102 of these loads could resolve the location.
3103
3104 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3105 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3106 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3107 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3108 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3109 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3110 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3111 breakpoints.
3112
3113 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3114
3115 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3116 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3117 @table @code
3118 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3119 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3120 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3121 breakpoint must be used.
3122
3123 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3124 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3125 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3126 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3127 @end table
3128
3129
3130 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3131 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3132 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3133 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3134 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3135 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3136 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3137 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3138
3139
3140 @node Set Watchpoints
3141 @subsection Setting watchpoints
3142
3143 @cindex setting watchpoints
3144 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3145 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3146 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3147 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3148 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3149
3150 @itemize @bullet
3151 @item
3152 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3153
3154 @item
3155 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3156 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3157 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3158
3159 @item
3160 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3161 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3162 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3163 @end itemize
3164
3165 @cindex software watchpoints
3166 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3167 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3168 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3169 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3170 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3171 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3172 culprit.)
3173
3174 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3175 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3176 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3177
3178 @table @code
3179 @kindex watch
3180 @item watch @var{expr}
3181 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3182 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3183 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3184 to watch the value of a single variable:
3185
3186 @smallexample
3187 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3188 @end smallexample
3189
3190 @kindex rwatch
3191 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3192 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3193 by the program.
3194
3195 @kindex awatch
3196 @item awatch @var{expr}
3197 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3198 or written into by the program.
3199
3200 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3201 @item info watchpoints
3202 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3203 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3204 @end table
3205
3206 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3207 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3208 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3209 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3210 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3211 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3212
3213 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3214 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3215 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3216 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3217 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3218 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3219 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3220 mechanism of watching expressiion values.)
3221
3222 @table @code
3223 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3224 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3225 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3226
3227 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3228 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3229 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3230 @end table
3231
3232 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3233 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3234 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3235
3236 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3237
3238 @smallexample
3239 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3240 @end smallexample
3241
3242 @noindent
3243 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3244
3245 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3246 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3247 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3248 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3249 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3250 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3251 will print a message like this:
3252
3253 @smallexample
3254 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3255 @end smallexample
3256
3257 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3258 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3259 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3260 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3261 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3262 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3263 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3264 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3265
3266 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3267 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3268 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3269 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3270 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3271 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3272
3273 @smallexample
3274 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @noindent
3278 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3279
3280 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3281 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3282 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3283 expression with separately allocated resources.
3284
3285 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3286 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3287 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3288 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3289 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3290 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3291 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3292 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3293 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3294 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3295
3296 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3297 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3298 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3299
3300 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3301 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3302 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3303 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3304 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3305 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3306 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3307 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3308 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3309
3310 @quotation
3311 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3312 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3313 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3314 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3315 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3316 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3317 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3318 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3319 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3320 the expression.
3321
3322 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3323 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3324 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3325 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3326 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3327 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3328 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3329 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3330 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3331 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3332 @end quotation
3333
3334 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3335
3336 @node Set Catchpoints
3337 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3338 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3339 @cindex exception handlers
3340 @cindex event handling
3341
3342 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3343 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3344 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3345
3346 @table @code
3347 @kindex catch
3348 @item catch @var{event}
3349 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3350 @table @code
3351 @item throw
3352 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3353 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3354
3355 @item catch
3356 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3357
3358 @item exception
3359 @cindex Ada exception catching
3360 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3361 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3362 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3363 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3364 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3365
3366 @item exception unhandled
3367 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3368
3369 @item assert
3370 A failed Ada assertion.
3371
3372 @item exec
3373 @cindex break on fork/exec
3374 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3375
3376 @item fork
3377 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3378
3379 @item vfork
3380 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3381
3382 @item load
3383 @itemx load @var{libname}
3384 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3385 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3386 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3387
3388 @item unload
3389 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3390 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3391 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3392 @end table
3393
3394 @item tcatch @var{event}
3395 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3396 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3397
3398 @end table
3399
3400 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3401
3402 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3403 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3404
3405 @itemize @bullet
3406 @item
3407 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3408 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3409 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3410 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3411 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3412 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3413 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3414 disabled within interactive calls.
3415
3416 @item
3417 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3418
3419 @item
3420 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3421 @end itemize
3422
3423 @cindex raise exceptions
3424 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3425 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3426 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3427 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3428 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3429 out where the exception was raised.
3430
3431 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3432 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3433 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3434 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3435
3436 @smallexample
3437 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3438 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3439 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3440 @end smallexample
3441
3442 @noindent
3443 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3444 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3445 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3446
3447 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3448 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3449 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3450 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3451 raised.
3452
3453
3454 @node Delete Breaks
3455 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3456
3457 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3458 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3459 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3460 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3461 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3462 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3463
3464 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3465 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3466 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3467 their breakpoint numbers.
3468
3469 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3470 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3471 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3472
3473 @table @code
3474 @kindex clear
3475 @item clear
3476 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3477 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3478 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3479 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3480
3481 @item clear @var{function}
3482 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3483 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3484
3485 @item clear @var{linenum}
3486 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3487 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3488 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3489
3490 @cindex delete breakpoints
3491 @kindex delete
3492 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3493 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3494 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3495 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3496 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3497 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3498 @end table
3499
3500 @node Disabling
3501 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3502
3503 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3504 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3505 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3506 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3507 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3508
3509 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3510 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3511 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3512 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3513 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3514
3515 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3516 states of enablement:
3517
3518 @itemize @bullet
3519 @item
3520 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3521 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3522 @item
3523 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3524 @item
3525 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3526 disabled.
3527 @item
3528 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3529 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3530 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3531 @end itemize
3532
3533 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3534 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3535
3536 @table @code
3537 @kindex disable
3538 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3539 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3540 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3541 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3542 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3543 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3544 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3545
3546 @kindex enable
3547 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3548 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3549 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3550
3551 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3552 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3553 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3554
3555 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3556 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3557 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3558 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3559 @end table
3560
3561 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3562 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3563 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3564 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3565 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3566 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3567 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3568 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3569 stepping}.)
3570
3571 @node Conditions
3572 @subsection Break conditions
3573 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3574 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3575
3576 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3577 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3578 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3579 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3580 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3581 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3582 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3583 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3584
3585 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3586 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3587 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3588 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3589 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3590
3591 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3592 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3593 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3594 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3595 one.
3596
3597 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3598 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3599 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3600 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3601 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3602 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3603 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3604 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3605 conditions for the
3606 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3607 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3608
3609 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3610 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3611 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3612 with the @code{condition} command.
3613
3614 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3615 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3616 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3617 catchpoint.
3618
3619 @table @code
3620 @kindex condition
3621 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3622 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3623 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3624 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3625 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3626 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3627 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3628 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3629 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3630 prints an error message:
3631
3632 @smallexample
3633 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3634 @end smallexample
3635
3636 @noindent
3637 @value{GDBN} does
3638 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3639 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3640 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3641
3642 @item condition @var{bnum}
3643 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3644 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3645 @end table
3646
3647 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3648 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3649 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3650 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3651 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3652 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3653 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3654 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3655 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3656 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3657 your program reaches it.
3658
3659 @table @code
3660 @kindex ignore
3661 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3662 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3663 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3664 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3665 takes no action.
3666
3667 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3668 a count of zero.
3669
3670 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3671 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3672 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3673 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3674
3675 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3676 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3677 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3678
3679 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3680 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3681 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3682 variables}.
3683 @end table
3684
3685 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3686
3687
3688 @node Break Commands
3689 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3690
3691 @cindex breakpoint commands
3692 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3693 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3694 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3695 enable other breakpoints.
3696
3697 @table @code
3698 @kindex commands
3699 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3700 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3701 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3702 @itemx end
3703 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3704 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3705 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3706
3707 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3708 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3709
3710 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3711 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3712 recently encountered).
3713 @end table
3714
3715 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3716 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3717
3718 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3719 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3720 that resumes execution.
3721
3722 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3723 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3724 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3725 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3726 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3727
3728 @kindex silent
3729 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3730 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3731 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3732 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3733 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3734 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3735
3736 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3737 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3738 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3739
3740 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3741 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3742
3743 @smallexample
3744 break foo if x>0
3745 commands
3746 silent
3747 printf "x is %d\n",x
3748 cont
3749 end
3750 @end smallexample
3751
3752 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3753 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3754 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3755 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3756 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3757 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3758 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3759
3760 @smallexample
3761 break 403
3762 commands
3763 silent
3764 set x = y + 4
3765 cont
3766 end
3767 @end smallexample
3768
3769 @node Breakpoint Menus
3770 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3771 @cindex overloading
3772 @cindex symbol overloading
3773
3774 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3775 single function name
3776 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3777 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3778 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3779 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3780 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3781 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3782 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3783 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3784 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3785 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3786 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3787 breakpoints.
3788
3789 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3790 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3791 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3792
3793 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3794 @smallexample
3795 @group
3796 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3797 [0] cancel
3798 [1] all
3799 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3800 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3801 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3802 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3803 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3804 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3805 > 2 4 6
3806 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3807 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3808 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3809 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3810 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3811 breakpoints.
3812 (@value{GDBP})
3813 @end group
3814 @end smallexample
3815
3816 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3817 @node Error in Breakpoints
3818 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3819 @c
3820 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3821 @c
3822 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3823 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3824 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3825 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3826
3827 @smallexample
3828 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3829 The same program may be running in another process.
3830 @end smallexample
3831
3832 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3833
3834 @enumerate
3835 @item
3836 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3837
3838 @item
3839 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3840 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3841 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3842 Then start your program again.
3843
3844 @item
3845 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3846 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3847 to nonsharable executables.
3848 @end enumerate
3849 @c @end ifclear
3850
3851 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3852 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3853
3854 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3855 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3856 @smallexample
3857 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3858 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3859 @end smallexample
3860
3861 @noindent
3862 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3863 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3864 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3865
3866 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3867 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3868
3869 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3870 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3871 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3872
3873 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3874 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3875 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3876 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3877
3878 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3879 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3880 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3881 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3882 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3883 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3884 first in the bundle.
3885
3886 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3887 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3888 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3889 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3890 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3891 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3892 is hit.
3893
3894 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3895 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3896
3897 @smallexample
3898 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3899 @end smallexample
3900
3901 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3902 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3903 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3904 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3905 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3906 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3907 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3908 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3909
3910 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3911 adjusted breakpoints:
3912
3913 @smallexample
3914 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3915 to 0x00010410.
3916 @end smallexample
3917
3918 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3919 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3920 frequently than expected.
3921
3922 @node Continuing and Stepping
3923 @section Continuing and stepping
3924
3925 @cindex stepping
3926 @cindex continuing
3927 @cindex resuming execution
3928 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3929 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3930 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3931 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3932 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3933 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3934 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3935 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3936
3937 @table @code
3938 @kindex continue
3939 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3940 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3941 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3942 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3943 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3944 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3945 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3946 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3947 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3948 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3949
3950 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3951 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3952 @code{continue} is ignored.
3953
3954 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3955 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3956 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3957 @code{continue}.
3958 @end table
3959
3960 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3961 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3962 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3963 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3964
3965 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3966 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3967 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3968 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3969 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3970 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3971
3972 @table @code
3973 @kindex step
3974 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3975 @item step
3976 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3977 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3978 abbreviated @code{s}.
3979
3980 @quotation
3981 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3982 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3983 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3984 @c distinction here.
3985 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3986 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3987 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3988 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3989 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3990 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3991 below.
3992 @end quotation
3993
3994 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3995 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3996 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3997 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3998 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3999 called within the line.
4000
4001 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4002 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4003 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4004 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4005 was any debugging information about the routine.
4006
4007 @item step @var{count}
4008 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4009 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4010 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4011
4012 @kindex next
4013 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4014 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4015 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4016 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4017 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4018 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4019 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4020 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4021
4022 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4023
4024
4025 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4026 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4027 @c
4028 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4029 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4030 @c function are executed without stopping.
4031
4032 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4033 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4034 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4035
4036 @kindex set step-mode
4037 @item set step-mode
4038 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4039 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4040 @itemx set step-mode on
4041 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4042 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4043 information rather than stepping over it.
4044
4045 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4046 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4047 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4048
4049 @item set step-mode off
4050 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4051 debug information. This is the default.
4052
4053 @item show step-mode
4054 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4055 source line debug information.
4056
4057 @kindex finish
4058 @item finish
4059 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4060 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4061
4062 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4063 ,Returning from a function}).
4064
4065 @kindex until
4066 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4067 @cindex run until specified location
4068 @item until
4069 @itemx u
4070 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4071 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4072 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4073 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4074 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4075 than the address of the jump.
4076
4077 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4078 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4079 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4080 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4081 through the next iteration.
4082
4083 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4084 stack frame.
4085
4086 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4087 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4088 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4089 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4090 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4091
4092 @smallexample
4093 (@value{GDBP}) f
4094 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4095 206 expand_input();
4096 (@value{GDBP}) until
4097 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4098 @end smallexample
4099
4100 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4101 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4102 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4103 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4104 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4105 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4106 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4107
4108 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4109 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4110 argument.
4111
4112 @item until @var{location}
4113 @itemx u @var{location}
4114 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4115 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4116 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4117 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4118 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4119 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4120 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4121 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4122 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4123 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
4124 invocations have returned.
4125
4126 @smallexample
4127 94 int factorial (int value)
4128 95 @{
4129 96 if (value > 1) @{
4130 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4131 98 @}
4132 99 return (value);
4133 100 @}
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136
4137 @kindex advance @var{location}
4138 @itemx advance @var{location}
4139 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4140 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4141 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4142 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4143 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4144 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4145
4146
4147 @kindex stepi
4148 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4149 @item stepi
4150 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4151 @itemx si
4152 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4153
4154 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4155 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4156 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4157 Display,, Automatic display}.
4158
4159 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4160
4161 @need 750
4162 @kindex nexti
4163 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4164 @item nexti
4165 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4166 @itemx ni
4167 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4168 proceed until the function returns.
4169
4170 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4171 @end table
4172
4173 @node Signals
4174 @section Signals
4175 @cindex signals
4176
4177 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4178 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4179 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4180 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4181 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4182 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4183 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4184 requested an alarm).
4185
4186 @cindex fatal signals
4187 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4188 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4189 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4190 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4191 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4192 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4193
4194 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4195 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4196 signal.
4197
4198 @cindex handling signals
4199 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4200 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4201 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4202 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4203 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4204
4205 @table @code
4206 @kindex info signals
4207 @kindex info handle
4208 @item info signals
4209 @itemx info handle
4210 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4211 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4212 the defined types of signals.
4213
4214 @item info signals @var{sig}
4215 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4216
4217 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4218
4219 @kindex handle
4220 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4221 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4222 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4223 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4224 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4225 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4226 say what change to make.
4227 @end table
4228
4229 @c @group
4230 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4231 Their full names are:
4232
4233 @table @code
4234 @item nostop
4235 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4236 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4237
4238 @item stop
4239 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4240 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4241
4242 @item print
4243 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4244
4245 @item noprint
4246 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4247 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4248
4249 @item pass
4250 @itemx noignore
4251 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4252 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4253 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4254
4255 @item nopass
4256 @itemx ignore
4257 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4258 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4259 @end table
4260 @c @end group
4261
4262 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4263 program until you
4264 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4265 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4266 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4267 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4268 program sees that signal when you continue.
4269
4270 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4271 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4272 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4273 erroneous signals.
4274
4275 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4276 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4277 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4278 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4279 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4280 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4281 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4282 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4283 program a signal}.
4284
4285 @node Thread Stops
4286 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4287
4288 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4289 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4290 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4291
4292 @table @code
4293 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4294 @cindex thread breakpoints
4295 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4296 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4297 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4298 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4299 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4300
4301 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4302 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4303 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4304 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4305 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4306
4307 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4308 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4309 program.
4310
4311 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4312 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4313 breakpoint condition, like this:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4317 @end smallexample
4318
4319 @end table
4320
4321 @cindex stopped threads
4322 @cindex threads, stopped
4323 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4324 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4325 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4326 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4327 underfoot.
4328
4329 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4330 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4331 @cindex premature return from system calls
4332 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4333 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4334 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4335 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4336 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4337 stop execution.
4338
4339 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4340 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4341 style anyways.
4342
4343 For example, do not write code like this:
4344
4345 @smallexample
4346 sleep (10);
4347 @end smallexample
4348
4349 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4350 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4351
4352 Instead, write this:
4353
4354 @smallexample
4355 int unslept = 10;
4356 while (unslept > 0)
4357 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4361 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4362 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4363 @value{GDBN}.
4364
4365 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4366 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4367 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4368 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4369
4370 @cindex continuing threads
4371 @cindex threads, continuing
4372 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4373 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4374 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4375
4376 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4377 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4378 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4379 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4380 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4381 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4382 stops.
4383
4384 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4385 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4386 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4387 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4388
4389 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4390 thread to run.
4391
4392 @table @code
4393 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4394 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4395 @cindex lock scheduler
4396 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4397 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4398 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4399 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4400 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4401 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4402 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4403 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4404 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4405 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4406 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4407
4408 @item show scheduler-locking
4409 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4410 @end table
4411
4412
4413 @node Stack
4414 @chapter Examining the Stack
4415
4416 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4417 stopped and how it got there.
4418
4419 @cindex call stack
4420 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4421 is generated.
4422 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4423 the arguments of the call,
4424 and the local variables of the function being called.
4425 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4426 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4427 stack}.
4428
4429 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4430 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4431
4432 @cindex selected frame
4433 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4434 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4435 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4436 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4437 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4438 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4439
4440 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4441 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4442 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4443
4444 @menu
4445 * Frames:: Stack frames
4446 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4447 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4448 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4449
4450 @end menu
4451
4452 @node Frames
4453 @section Stack frames
4454
4455 @cindex frame, definition
4456 @cindex stack frame
4457 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4458 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4459 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4460 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4461 which the function is executing.
4462
4463 @cindex initial frame
4464 @cindex outermost frame
4465 @cindex innermost frame
4466 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4467 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4468 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4469 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4470 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4471 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4472 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4473 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4474
4475 @cindex frame pointer
4476 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4477 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4478 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4479 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4480 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4481 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4482
4483 @cindex frame number
4484 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4485 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4486 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4487 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4488 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4489
4490 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4491 @c underflow problems.
4492 @cindex frameless execution
4493 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4494 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
4495 @smallexample
4496 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4497 @end smallexample
4498 generates functions without a frame.)
4499 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4500 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4501 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4502 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4503 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4504 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4505 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4506
4507 @table @code
4508 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4509 @cindex current stack frame
4510 @item frame @var{args}
4511 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4512 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4513 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4514 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4515
4516 @kindex select-frame
4517 @cindex selecting frame silently
4518 @item select-frame
4519 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4520 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4521 @code{frame}.
4522 @end table
4523
4524 @node Backtrace
4525 @section Backtraces
4526
4527 @cindex traceback
4528 @cindex call stack traces
4529 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4530 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4531 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4532 stack.
4533
4534 @table @code
4535 @kindex backtrace
4536 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4537 @item backtrace
4538 @itemx bt
4539 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4540 frames in the stack.
4541
4542 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4543 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4544
4545 @item backtrace @var{n}
4546 @itemx bt @var{n}
4547 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4548
4549 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4550 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4551 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4552
4553 @item backtrace full
4554 @itemx bt full
4555 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4556 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4557 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4558 number of frames to print, as described above.
4559 @end table
4560
4561 @kindex where
4562 @kindex info stack
4563 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4564 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4565
4566 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4567 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4568 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4569 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4570 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4571 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4572 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4573 multi-threaded program.
4574
4575 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4576 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4577 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4578 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4579 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4580 line number.
4581
4582 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4583 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4584
4585 @smallexample
4586 @group
4587 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4588 at builtin.c:993
4589 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4590 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4591 at macro.c:71
4592 (More stack frames follow...)
4593 @end group
4594 @end smallexample
4595
4596 @noindent
4597 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4598 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4599 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4600
4601 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4602 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4603 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4604 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4605 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4606 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4607 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4608 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4609 such a backtrace might look like:
4610
4611 @smallexample
4612 @group
4613 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4614 at builtin.c:993
4615 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4616 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4617 at macro.c:71
4618 (More stack frames follow...)
4619 @end group
4620 @end smallexample
4621
4622 @noindent
4623 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4624 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4625
4626 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4627 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4628 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4629
4630 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4631 @cindex program entry point
4632 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4633 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4634 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4635 @code{main}@footnote{
4636 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4637 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4638 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4639 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4640 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4641 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4642
4643 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4644 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4645
4646 @table @code
4647 @item set backtrace past-main
4648 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4649 @kindex set backtrace
4650 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4651
4652 @item set backtrace past-main off
4653 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4654 default.
4655
4656 @item show backtrace past-main
4657 @kindex show backtrace
4658 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4659
4660 @item set backtrace past-entry
4661 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4662 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4663 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4664 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4665
4666 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4667 Backtraces will stop when they encouter the internal entry point of an
4668 application. This is the default.
4669
4670 @item show backtrace past-entry
4671 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4672
4673 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4674 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4675 @cindex backtrace limit
4676 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4677 unlimited.
4678
4679 @item show backtrace limit
4680 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4681 @end table
4682
4683 @node Selection
4684 @section Selecting a frame
4685
4686 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4687 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4688 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4689 of the stack frame just selected.
4690
4691 @table @code
4692 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4693 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4694 @item frame @var{n}
4695 @itemx f @var{n}
4696 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4697 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4698 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4699 @code{main}.
4700
4701 @item frame @var{addr}
4702 @itemx f @var{addr}
4703 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4704 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4705 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4706 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4707 switches between them.
4708
4709 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4710 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4711
4712 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4713 pointer and a program counter.
4714
4715 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4716 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4717
4718 @kindex up
4719 @item up @var{n}
4720 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4721 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4722 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4723
4724 @kindex down
4725 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4726 @item down @var{n}
4727 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4728 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4729 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4730 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4731 @end table
4732
4733 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4734 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4735 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4736 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4737
4738 @need 1000
4739 For example:
4740
4741 @smallexample
4742 @group
4743 (@value{GDBP}) up
4744 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4745 at env.c:10
4746 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4747 @end group
4748 @end smallexample
4749
4750 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4751 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4752 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4753 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4754 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4755 for details.
4756
4757 @table @code
4758 @kindex down-silently
4759 @kindex up-silently
4760 @item up-silently @var{n}
4761 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4762 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4763 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4764 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4765 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4766 distracting.
4767 @end table
4768
4769 @node Frame Info
4770 @section Information about a frame
4771
4772 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4773 stack frame.
4774
4775 @table @code
4776 @item frame
4777 @itemx f
4778 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4779 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4780 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4781 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4782 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4783
4784 @kindex info frame
4785 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4786 @item info frame
4787 @itemx info f
4788 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4789 including:
4790
4791 @itemize @bullet
4792 @item
4793 the address of the frame
4794 @item
4795 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4796 @item
4797 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4798 @item
4799 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4800 @item
4801 the address of the frame's arguments
4802 @item
4803 the address of the frame's local variables
4804 @item
4805 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4806 @item
4807 which registers were saved in the frame
4808 @end itemize
4809
4810 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4811 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4812 the usual conventions.
4813
4814 @item info frame @var{addr}
4815 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4816 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4817 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4818 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4819 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4820 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4821
4822 @kindex info args
4823 @item info args
4824 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4825
4826 @item info locals
4827 @kindex info locals
4828 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4829 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4830 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4831
4832 @kindex info catch
4833 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4834 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4835 @item info catch
4836 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4837 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4838 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4839 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4840 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4841
4842 @end table
4843
4844
4845 @node Source
4846 @chapter Examining Source Files
4847
4848 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4849 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4850 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4851 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4852 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4853 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4854 source files by explicit command.
4855
4856 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4857 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4858 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4859
4860 @menu
4861 * List:: Printing source lines
4862 * Edit:: Editing source files
4863 * Search:: Searching source files
4864 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4865 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4866 @end menu
4867
4868 @node List
4869 @section Printing source lines
4870
4871 @kindex list
4872 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4873 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4874 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4875 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4876
4877 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4878
4879 @table @code
4880 @item list @var{linenum}
4881 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4882 current source file.
4883
4884 @item list @var{function}
4885 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4886 @var{function}.
4887
4888 @item list
4889 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4890 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4891 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4892 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4893 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4894
4895 @item list -
4896 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4897 @end table
4898
4899 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4900 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4901 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4902
4903 @table @code
4904 @kindex set listsize
4905 @item set listsize @var{count}
4906 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4907 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4908
4909 @kindex show listsize
4910 @item show listsize
4911 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4912 @end table
4913
4914 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4915 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4916 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4917 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4918 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4919
4920 @cindex linespec
4921 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4922 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4923 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4924 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4925
4926 @table @code
4927 @item list @var{linespec}
4928 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4929
4930 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4931 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4932 linespecs.
4933
4934 @item list ,@var{last}
4935 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4936
4937 @item list @var{first},
4938 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4939
4940 @item list +
4941 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4942
4943 @item list -
4944 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4945
4946 @item list
4947 As described in the preceding table.
4948 @end table
4949
4950 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4951 kinds of linespec.
4952
4953 @table @code
4954 @item @var{number}
4955 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4956 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4957 the same source file as the first linespec.
4958
4959 @item +@var{offset}
4960 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4961 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4962 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4963 first linespec.
4964
4965 @item -@var{offset}
4966 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4967
4968 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4969 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4970
4971 @item @var{function}
4972 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4973 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4974
4975 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4976 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4977 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4978 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4979 identically named functions in different source files.
4980
4981 @item *@var{address}
4982 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4983 @var{address} may be any expression.
4984 @end table
4985
4986 @node Edit
4987 @section Editing source files
4988 @cindex editing source files
4989
4990 @kindex edit
4991 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4992 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4993 The editing program of your choice
4994 is invoked with the current line set to
4995 the active line in the program.
4996 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4997 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4998
4999 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
5000
5001 @table @code
5002 @item edit
5003 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
5004
5005 @item edit @var{number}
5006 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5007
5008 @item edit @var{function}
5009 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5010
5011 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
5012 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
5013
5014 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
5015 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
5016 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
5017 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
5018 identically named functions in different source files.
5019
5020 @item edit *@var{address}
5021 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
5022 @var{address} may be any expression.
5023 @end table
5024
5025 @subsection Choosing your editor
5026 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5027 @footnote{
5028 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5029 following command-line syntax:
5030 @smallexample
5031 ex +@var{number} file
5032 @end smallexample
5033 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5034 the file where to start editing.}.
5035 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5036 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5037 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5038 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5039 @smallexample
5040 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5041 export EDITOR
5042 gdb @dots{}
5043 @end smallexample
5044 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5045 @smallexample
5046 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5047 gdb @dots{}
5048 @end smallexample
5049
5050 @node Search
5051 @section Searching source files
5052 @cindex searching source files
5053
5054 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5055 regular expression.
5056
5057 @table @code
5058 @kindex search
5059 @kindex forward-search
5060 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5061 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5062 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5063 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5064 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5065 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5066 @code{fo}.
5067
5068 @kindex reverse-search
5069 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5070 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5071 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5072 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5073 this command as @code{rev}.
5074 @end table
5075
5076 @node Source Path
5077 @section Specifying source directories
5078
5079 @cindex source path
5080 @cindex directories for source files
5081 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5082 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5083 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5084 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5085 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5086 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5087 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5088
5089 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5090 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5091 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5092 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5093 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5094 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5095 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5096 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5097 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5098 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5099 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5100
5101 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5102 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5103 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5104 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5105 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5106 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5107
5108 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5109 source files.
5110
5111 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5112 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5113 each line is in the file.
5114
5115 @kindex directory
5116 @kindex dir
5117 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5118 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5119 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5120
5121 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5122 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5123
5124 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5125 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5126 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5127 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5128 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5129 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5130 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5131 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5132 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5133 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5134 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5135 name to look up the sources.
5136
5137 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5138 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5139 GDB to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5140 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5141 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5142 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5143 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5144 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5145
5146 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5147 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5148 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5149 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5150 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5151 is applied only at the begining of the directory name, this rule will
5152 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5153
5154 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5155 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5156 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5157 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5158 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5159 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5160 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5161 command.
5162
5163 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5164 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5165 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5166 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5167 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5168 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5169 method available to point GDB at the new location.
5170
5171 @table @code
5172 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5173 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5174 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5175 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5176 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5177 part of absolute file names) or
5178 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5179 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5180
5181 @kindex cdir
5182 @kindex cwd
5183 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5184 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
5185 @cindex compilation directory
5186 @cindex current directory
5187 @cindex working directory
5188 @cindex directory, current
5189 @cindex directory, compilation
5190 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5191 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5192 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5193 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5194 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5195 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5196
5197 @item directory
5198 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5199
5200 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5201 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5202
5203 @item show directories
5204 @kindex show directories
5205 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5206
5207 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5208 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5209 @kindex set substitute-path
5210 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5211 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5212 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5213
5214 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5215 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5216
5217 @smallexample
5218 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5219 @end smallexample
5220
5221 @noindent
5222 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5223 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5224 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5225
5226 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5227 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5228 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5229 the substitution.
5230
5231 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5232
5233 @smallexample
5234 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5235 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5236 @end smallexample
5237
5238 @noindent
5239 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5240 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5241 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5242 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5243
5244
5245 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5246 @kindex unset substitute-path
5247 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5248 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5249 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5250
5251 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5252
5253 @item show substitute-path [path]
5254 @kindex show substitute-path
5255 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5256 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5257
5258 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5259 rules.
5260
5261 @end table
5262
5263 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5264 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5265 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5266
5267 @enumerate
5268 @item
5269 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5270
5271 @item
5272 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5273 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5274 directories in one command.
5275 @end enumerate
5276
5277 @node Machine Code
5278 @section Source and machine code
5279 @cindex source line and its code address
5280
5281 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5282 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5283 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5284 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5285 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5286 well as hex.
5287
5288 @table @code
5289 @kindex info line
5290 @item info line @var{linespec}
5291 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5292 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5293 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5294 source lines}).
5295 @end table
5296
5297 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5298 the object code for the first line of function
5299 @code{m4_changequote}:
5300
5301 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5302 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5303 @smallexample
5304 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5305 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5306 @end smallexample
5307
5308 @noindent
5309 @cindex code address and its source line
5310 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5311 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5312 @smallexample
5313 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5314 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5315 @end smallexample
5316
5317 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5318 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5319 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5320 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5321 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5322 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5323 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5324 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5325 variables}).
5326
5327 @table @code
5328 @kindex disassemble
5329 @cindex assembly instructions
5330 @cindex instructions, assembly
5331 @cindex machine instructions
5332 @cindex listing machine instructions
5333 @item disassemble
5334 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5335 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5336 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5337 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5338 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5339 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5340 @end table
5341
5342 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5343 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5344
5345 @smallexample
5346 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5347 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5348 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5349 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5350 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5351 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5352 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5353 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5354 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5355 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5356 End of assembler dump.
5357 @end smallexample
5358
5359 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5360 mnemonics or other syntax.
5361
5362 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5363 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5364 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5365 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5366 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5367
5368 @table @code
5369 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5370 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5371 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5372 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5373 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5374 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5375
5376 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5377 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5378 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5379 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5380
5381 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5382 @item show disassembly-flavor
5383 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5384 @end table
5385
5386
5387 @node Data
5388 @chapter Examining Data
5389
5390 @cindex printing data
5391 @cindex examining data
5392 @kindex print
5393 @kindex inspect
5394 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5395 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5396 @c different window or something like that.
5397 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5398 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5399 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5400 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5401 Different Languages}).
5402
5403 @table @code
5404 @item print @var{expr}
5405 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5406 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5407 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5408 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5409 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5410 formats}.
5411
5412 @item print
5413 @itemx print /@var{f}
5414 @cindex reprint the last value
5415 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5416 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5417 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5418 @end table
5419
5420 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5421 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5422 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5423
5424 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5425 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5426 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5427 Table}.
5428
5429 @menu
5430 * Expressions:: Expressions
5431 * Variables:: Program variables
5432 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5433 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5434 * Memory:: Examining memory
5435 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5436 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5437 * Value History:: Value history
5438 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5439 * Registers:: Registers
5440 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5441 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5442 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5443 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5444 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5445 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5446 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5447 character set than GDB does
5448 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5449 @end menu
5450
5451 @node Expressions
5452 @section Expressions
5453
5454 @cindex expressions
5455 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5456 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5457 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5458 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5459 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5460 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5461 @ref{Compilation}.
5462
5463 @cindex arrays in expressions
5464 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5465 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5466 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5467 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5468
5469 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5470 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5471 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5472 languages.
5473
5474 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5475 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5476
5477 @cindex casts, in expressions
5478 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5479 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5480 at that address in memory.
5481 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5482
5483 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5484 to programming languages:
5485
5486 @table @code
5487 @item @@
5488 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5489 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5490
5491 @item ::
5492 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5493 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5494
5495 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5496 @cindex type casting memory
5497 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5498 @cindex casts, to view memory
5499 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5500 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5501 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5502 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5503 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5504 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5505 @end table
5506
5507 @node Variables
5508 @section Program variables
5509
5510 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5511 in your program.
5512
5513 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5514 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5515
5516 @itemize @bullet
5517 @item
5518 global (or file-static)
5519 @end itemize
5520
5521 @noindent or
5522
5523 @itemize @bullet
5524 @item
5525 visible according to the scope rules of the
5526 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5527 @end itemize
5528
5529 @noindent This means that in the function
5530
5531 @smallexample
5532 foo (a)
5533 int a;
5534 @{
5535 bar (a);
5536 @{
5537 int b = test ();
5538 bar (b);
5539 @}
5540 @}
5541 @end smallexample
5542
5543 @noindent
5544 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5545 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5546 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5547 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5548
5549 @cindex variable name conflict
5550 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5551 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5552 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5553 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5554 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5555 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5556 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5557
5558 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5559 @iftex
5560 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5561 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5562 @end iftex
5563 @smallexample
5564 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5565 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5566 @end smallexample
5567
5568 @noindent
5569 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5570 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5571 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5572 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5573
5574 @smallexample
5575 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5576 @end smallexample
5577
5578 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5579 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5580 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5581 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5582 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5583 @c conflict?? --mew
5584
5585 @cindex wrong values
5586 @cindex variable values, wrong
5587 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5588 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5589 @quotation
5590 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5591 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5592 scope, and just before exit.
5593 @end quotation
5594 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5595 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5596 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5597 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5598 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5599 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5600 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5601 variable definitions may be gone.
5602
5603 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5604 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5605 when compiling.
5606
5607 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5608 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5609 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5610 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5611 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5612 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5613 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5614
5615 @smallexample
5616 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5617 @end smallexample
5618
5619 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5620 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5621 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5622 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5623 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5624 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5625 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5626 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
5627 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more info about debug info formats
5628 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5629
5630 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5631 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5632 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5633 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5634
5635 @node Arrays
5636 @section Artificial arrays
5637
5638 @cindex artificial array
5639 @cindex arrays
5640 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5641 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5642 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5643 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5644 program.
5645
5646 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5647 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5648 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5649 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5650 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5651 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5652 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5653 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5654 example. If a program says
5655
5656 @smallexample
5657 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5658 @end smallexample
5659
5660 @noindent
5661 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5662
5663 @smallexample
5664 p *array@@len
5665 @end smallexample
5666
5667 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5668 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5669 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5670 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5671 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5672
5673 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5674 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5675 The value need not be in memory:
5676 @smallexample
5677 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5678 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5679 @end smallexample
5680
5681 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5682 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5683 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5684 @smallexample
5685 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5686 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5687 @end smallexample
5688
5689 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5690 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5691 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5692 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5693 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5694 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5695 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5696 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5697 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5698 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5699
5700 @smallexample
5701 set $i = 0
5702 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5703 @key{RET}
5704 @key{RET}
5705 @dots{}
5706 @end smallexample
5707
5708 @node Output Formats
5709 @section Output formats
5710
5711 @cindex formatted output
5712 @cindex output formats
5713 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5714 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5715 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5716 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5717 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5718
5719 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5720 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5721 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5722 letters supported are:
5723
5724 @table @code
5725 @item x
5726 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5727 hexadecimal.
5728
5729 @item d
5730 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5731
5732 @item u
5733 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5734
5735 @item o
5736 Print as integer in octal.
5737
5738 @item t
5739 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5740 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5741 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5742 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5743
5744 @item a
5745 @cindex unknown address, locating
5746 @cindex locate address
5747 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5748 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5749 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5750
5751 @smallexample
5752 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5753 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5754 @end smallexample
5755
5756 @noindent
5757 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5758 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5759
5760 @item c
5761 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5762 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5763 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5764 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5765
5766 @item f
5767 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5768 using typical floating point syntax.
5769 @end table
5770
5771 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5772
5773 @smallexample
5774 p/x $pc
5775 @end smallexample
5776
5777 @noindent
5778 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5779 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5780
5781 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5782 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5783 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5784
5785 @node Memory
5786 @section Examining memory
5787
5788 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5789 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5790
5791 @cindex examining memory
5792 @table @code
5793 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5794 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5795 @itemx x @var{addr}
5796 @itemx x
5797 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5798 @end table
5799
5800 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5801 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5802 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5803 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5804 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5805
5806 @table @r
5807 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5808 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5809 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5810 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5811 @c 4.1.2.
5812
5813 @item @var{f}, the display format
5814 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5815 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5816 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5817 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5818 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5819 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5820
5821 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5822 The unit size is any of
5823
5824 @table @code
5825 @item b
5826 Bytes.
5827 @item h
5828 Halfwords (two bytes).
5829 @item w
5830 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5831 @item g
5832 Giant words (eight bytes).
5833 @end table
5834
5835 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5836 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5837 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5838
5839 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5840 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5841 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5842 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5843 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5844 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5845 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5846 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5847 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5848 a value from memory).
5849 @end table
5850
5851 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5852 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5853 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5854 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5855 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5856
5857 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5858 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5859 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5860 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5861 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5862
5863 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5864 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5865 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5866 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5867 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5868 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5869
5870 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5871 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5872 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5873 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5874 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5875 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5876 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5877
5878 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5879 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5880 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5881 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5882 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5883 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5884 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5885 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5886 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5887
5888 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5889 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5890 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5891
5892 @cindex remote memory comparison
5893 @cindex verify remote memory image
5894 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5895 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5896 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5897 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5898 situations.
5899
5900 @table @code
5901 @kindex compare-sections
5902 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5903 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5904 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5905 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5906 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5907 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5908 remote request.
5909 @end table
5910
5911 @node Auto Display
5912 @section Automatic display
5913 @cindex automatic display
5914 @cindex display of expressions
5915
5916 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5917 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5918 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5919 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5920 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5921 The automatic display looks like this:
5922
5923 @smallexample
5924 2: foo = 38
5925 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5926 @end smallexample
5927
5928 @noindent
5929 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5930 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5931 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5932 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5933 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5934 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5935 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5936
5937 @table @code
5938 @kindex display
5939 @item display @var{expr}
5940 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5941 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5942
5943 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5944
5945 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5946 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5947 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5948 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5949 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5950
5951 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5952 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5953 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5954 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5955 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5956 @end table
5957
5958 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5959 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5960 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5961
5962 @table @code
5963 @kindex delete display
5964 @kindex undisplay
5965 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5966 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5967 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5968
5969 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5970 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5971
5972 @kindex disable display
5973 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5974 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5975 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5976 enabled again later.
5977
5978 @kindex enable display
5979 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5980 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5981 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5982
5983 @item display
5984 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5985 done when your program stops.
5986
5987 @kindex info display
5988 @item info display
5989 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5990 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5991 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5992 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5993 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5994 @end table
5995
5996 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5997 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5998 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5999 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6000 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6001 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6002 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6003 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6004 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6005 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6006 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6007
6008 @node Print Settings
6009 @section Print settings
6010
6011 @cindex format options
6012 @cindex print settings
6013 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6014 and symbols are printed.
6015
6016 @noindent
6017 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6018
6019 @table @code
6020 @kindex set print
6021 @item set print address
6022 @itemx set print address on
6023 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6024 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6025 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6026 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6027 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6028 @code{set print address on}:
6029
6030 @smallexample
6031 @group
6032 (@value{GDBP}) f
6033 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6034 at input.c:530
6035 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6036 @end group
6037 @end smallexample
6038
6039 @item set print address off
6040 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6041 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6042
6043 @smallexample
6044 @group
6045 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6046 (@value{GDBP}) f
6047 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6048 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6049 @end group
6050 @end smallexample
6051
6052 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6053 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6054 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6055 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6056
6057 @kindex show print
6058 @item show print address
6059 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6060 @end table
6061
6062 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6063 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6064 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6065 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6066 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6067 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6068 it prints a symbolic address:
6069
6070 @table @code
6071 @item set print symbol-filename on
6072 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6073 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6074 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6075 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6076
6077 @item set print symbol-filename off
6078 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6079 default.
6080
6081 @item show print symbol-filename
6082 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6083 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6084 @end table
6085
6086 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6087 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6088 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6089
6090 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6091 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6092
6093 @table @code
6094 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6095 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6096 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6097 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6098 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6099 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6100
6101 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6102 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6103 symbolic address.
6104 @end table
6105
6106 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6107 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6108 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6109 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6110 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6111 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6112 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6113 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6117 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6118 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6119 @end smallexample
6120
6121 @quotation
6122 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6123 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6124 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6125 @end quotation
6126
6127 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6128
6129 @table @code
6130 @item set print array
6131 @itemx set print array on
6132 @cindex pretty print arrays
6133 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6134 but uses more space. The default is off.
6135
6136 @item set print array off
6137 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6138
6139 @item show print array
6140 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6141 arrays.
6142
6143 @cindex print array indexes
6144 @item set print array-indexes
6145 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6146 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6147 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6148 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6149
6150 @item set print array-indexes off
6151 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6152
6153 @item show print array-indexes
6154 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6155 arrays.
6156
6157 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6158 @cindex number of array elements to print
6159 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6160 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6161 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6162 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6163 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6164 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6165 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6166
6167 @item show print elements
6168 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6169 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6170
6171 @item set print repeats
6172 @cindex repeated array elements
6173 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6174 elelments. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6175 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6176 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6177 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6178 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6179 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6180
6181 @item show print repeats
6182 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6183 elements.
6184
6185 @item set print null-stop
6186 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6187 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6188 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6189 contain only short strings.
6190 The default is off.
6191
6192 @item show print null-stop
6193 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6194 @sc{null} character.
6195
6196 @item set print pretty on
6197 @cindex print structures in indented form
6198 @cindex indentation in structure display
6199 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6200 per line, like this:
6201
6202 @smallexample
6203 @group
6204 $1 = @{
6205 next = 0x0,
6206 flags = @{
6207 sweet = 1,
6208 sour = 1
6209 @},
6210 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6211 @}
6212 @end group
6213 @end smallexample
6214
6215 @item set print pretty off
6216 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6217
6218 @smallexample
6219 @group
6220 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6221 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6222 @end group
6223 @end smallexample
6224
6225 @noindent
6226 This is the default format.
6227
6228 @item show print pretty
6229 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6230
6231 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6232 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6233 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6234 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6235 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6236 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6237 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6238 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6239
6240 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6241 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6242 international character sets, and is the default.
6243
6244 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6245 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6246
6247 @item set print union on
6248 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6249 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6250 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6251
6252 @item set print union off
6253 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6254 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6255 instead.
6256
6257 @item show print union
6258 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6259 structures and other unions.
6260
6261 For example, given the declarations
6262
6263 @smallexample
6264 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6265 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6266 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6267 Bug_forms;
6268
6269 struct thing @{
6270 Species it;
6271 union @{
6272 Tree_forms tree;
6273 Bug_forms bug;
6274 @} form;
6275 @};
6276
6277 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6278 @end smallexample
6279
6280 @noindent
6281 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6282
6283 @smallexample
6284 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6285 @end smallexample
6286
6287 @noindent
6288 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6289
6290 @smallexample
6291 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6292 @end smallexample
6293
6294 @noindent
6295 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6296 and in Pascal.
6297 @end table
6298
6299 @need 1000
6300 @noindent
6301 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6302
6303 @table @code
6304 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6305 @item set print demangle
6306 @itemx set print demangle on
6307 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6308 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6309 linkage. The default is on.
6310
6311 @item show print demangle
6312 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6313
6314 @item set print asm-demangle
6315 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6316 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6317 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6318 The default is off.
6319
6320 @item show print asm-demangle
6321 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6322 or demangled form.
6323
6324 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6325 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6326 @kindex set demangle-style
6327 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6328 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6329 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6330
6331 @table @code
6332 @item auto
6333 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6334
6335 @item gnu
6336 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6337 This is the default.
6338
6339 @item hp
6340 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6341
6342 @item lucid
6343 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6344
6345 @item arm
6346 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6347 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6348 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6349 require further enhancement to permit that.
6350
6351 @end table
6352 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6353
6354 @item show demangle-style
6355 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6356
6357 @item set print object
6358 @itemx set print object on
6359 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6360 @cindex display derived types
6361 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6362 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6363 the virtual function table.
6364
6365 @item set print object off
6366 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6367 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6368
6369 @item show print object
6370 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6371
6372 @item set print static-members
6373 @itemx set print static-members on
6374 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6375 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6376
6377 @item set print static-members off
6378 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6379
6380 @item show print static-members
6381 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6382
6383 @item set print pascal_static-members
6384 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6385 @cindex static members of Pacal objects
6386 @cindex Pacal objects, static members display
6387 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6388
6389 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6390 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6391
6392 @item show print pascal_static-members
6393 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6394
6395 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6396 @item set print vtbl
6397 @itemx set print vtbl on
6398 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6399 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6400 @cindex VTBL display
6401 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6402 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6403 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6404
6405 @item set print vtbl off
6406 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6407
6408 @item show print vtbl
6409 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6410 @end table
6411
6412 @node Value History
6413 @section Value history
6414
6415 @cindex value history
6416 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6417 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6418 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6419 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6420 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6421 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6422 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6423 symbol table.
6424
6425 @cindex @code{$}
6426 @cindex @code{$$}
6427 @cindex history number
6428 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6429 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6430 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6431 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6432 history number.
6433
6434 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6435 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6436 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6437 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6438 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6439 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6440 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6441
6442 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6443 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6444
6445 @smallexample
6446 p *$
6447 @end smallexample
6448
6449 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6450 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6451
6452 @smallexample
6453 p *$.next
6454 @end smallexample
6455
6456 @noindent
6457 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6458 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6459
6460 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6461 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6462
6463 @smallexample
6464 print x
6465 set x=5
6466 @end smallexample
6467
6468 @noindent
6469 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6470 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6471
6472 @table @code
6473 @kindex show values
6474 @item show values
6475 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6476 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6477 values} does not change the history.
6478
6479 @item show values @var{n}
6480 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6481
6482 @item show values +
6483 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6484 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6485 @end table
6486
6487 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6488 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6489
6490 @node Convenience Vars
6491 @section Convenience variables
6492
6493 @cindex convenience variables
6494 @cindex user-defined variables
6495 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6496 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6497 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6498 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6499 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6500
6501 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6502 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6503 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6504 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6505 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6506
6507 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6508 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6509 For example:
6510
6511 @smallexample
6512 set $foo = *object_ptr
6513 @end smallexample
6514
6515 @noindent
6516 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6517 @code{object_ptr}.
6518
6519 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6520 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6521 value with another assignment at any time.
6522
6523 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6524 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6525 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6526 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6527
6528 @table @code
6529 @kindex show convenience
6530 @cindex show all user variables
6531 @item show convenience
6532 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6533 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6534
6535 @kindex init-if-undefined
6536 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6537 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6538 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6539 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6540 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6541 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6542 override default values used in a command script.
6543
6544 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6545 any side-effects do not occur.
6546 @end table
6547
6548 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6549 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6550 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6551
6552 @smallexample
6553 set $i = 0
6554 print bar[$i++]->contents
6555 @end smallexample
6556
6557 @noindent
6558 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6559
6560 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6561 values likely to be useful.
6562
6563 @table @code
6564 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6565 @item $_
6566 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6567 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6568 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6569 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6570 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6571 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6572 to the type of @code{$__}.
6573
6574 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6575 @item $__
6576 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6577 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6578 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6579
6580 @item $_exitcode
6581 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6582 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6583 the program being debugged terminates.
6584 @end table
6585
6586 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6587 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6588 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6589
6590 @node Registers
6591 @section Registers
6592
6593 @cindex registers
6594 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6595 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6596 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6597 your machine.
6598
6599 @table @code
6600 @kindex info registers
6601 @item info registers
6602 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6603 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6604
6605 @kindex info all-registers
6606 @cindex floating point registers
6607 @item info all-registers
6608 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6609 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6610
6611 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6612 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6613 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6614 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6615 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6616 @end table
6617
6618 @cindex stack pointer register
6619 @cindex program counter register
6620 @cindex process status register
6621 @cindex frame pointer register
6622 @cindex standard registers
6623 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6624 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6625 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6626 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6627 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6628 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6629 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6630 you could print the program counter in hex with
6631
6632 @smallexample
6633 p/x $pc
6634 @end smallexample
6635
6636 @noindent
6637 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6638
6639 @smallexample
6640 x/i $pc
6641 @end smallexample
6642
6643 @noindent
6644 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6645 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6646 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6647 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6648 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6649 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6650 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6651
6652 @smallexample
6653 set $sp += 4
6654 @end smallexample
6655
6656 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6657 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6658 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6659 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6660 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6661 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6662 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6663
6664 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6665 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6666 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6667 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6668 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6669 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6670 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6671
6672 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6673 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6674 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6675 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6676 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6677 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6678 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6679 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6680 prints the data in both formats.
6681
6682 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6683 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6684 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6685 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6686 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6687 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6688 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6689
6690 @smallexample
6691 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6692 $1 = @{
6693 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6694 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6695 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6696 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6697 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6698 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6699 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6700 @}
6701 @end smallexample
6702
6703 @noindent
6704 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6705 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6706 value to a @code{struct} member:
6707
6708 @smallexample
6709 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6710 @end smallexample
6711
6712 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6713 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6714 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6715 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6716 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6717 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6718
6719 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6720 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6721 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6722 frame makes no difference.
6723
6724 @node Floating Point Hardware
6725 @section Floating point hardware
6726 @cindex floating point
6727
6728 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6729 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6730
6731 @table @code
6732 @kindex info float
6733 @item info float
6734 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6735 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6736 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6737 the ARM and x86 machines.
6738 @end table
6739
6740 @node Vector Unit
6741 @section Vector Unit
6742 @cindex vector unit
6743
6744 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6745 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6746
6747 @table @code
6748 @kindex info vector
6749 @item info vector
6750 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6751 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6752 @end table
6753
6754 @node OS Information
6755 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6756 @cindex OS information
6757
6758 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6759 you debug your program.
6760
6761 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6762 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6763 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6764 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6765 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6766 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6767 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6768 structure.
6769
6770 @table @code
6771 @item info udot
6772 @kindex info udot
6773 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6774 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6775 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6776 the @code{examine} command.
6777 @end table
6778
6779 @cindex auxiliary vector
6780 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6781 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6782 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6783 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6784 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6785 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6786 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6787 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6788 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6789 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6790 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6791 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6792
6793 @table @code
6794 @kindex info auxv
6795 @item info auxv
6796 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6797 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6798 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6799 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6800 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6801 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6802 an unrecognized tag.
6803 @end table
6804
6805
6806 @node Memory Region Attributes
6807 @section Memory region attributes
6808 @cindex memory region attributes
6809
6810 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6811 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6812 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6813 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6814 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6815 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6816 user can override the fetched regions.
6817
6818 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6819 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6820 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6821 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6822 all memory.
6823
6824 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6825 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6826
6827 @table @code
6828 @kindex mem
6829 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6830 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6831 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6832 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6833 case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6834 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6835
6836 @item mem auto
6837 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6838 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6839
6840 @kindex delete mem
6841 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6842 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6843 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6844
6845 @kindex disable mem
6846 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6847 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6848 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6849 It may be enabled again later.
6850
6851 @kindex enable mem
6852 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6853 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6854
6855 @kindex info mem
6856 @item info mem
6857 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6858 for each region:
6859
6860 @table @emph
6861 @item Memory Region Number
6862 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6863 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6864 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6865
6866 @item Lo Address
6867 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6868
6869 @item Hi Address
6870 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6871
6872 @item Attributes
6873 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6874 @end table
6875 @end table
6876
6877
6878 @subsection Attributes
6879
6880 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6881 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6882 write accesses to a memory region.
6883
6884 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6885 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6886 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6887
6888 @table @code
6889 @item ro
6890 Memory is read only.
6891 @item wo
6892 Memory is write only.
6893 @item rw
6894 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6895 @end table
6896
6897 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6898 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6899 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6900 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6901 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6902
6903 @table @code
6904 @item 8
6905 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6906 @item 16
6907 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6908 @item 32
6909 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6910 @item 64
6911 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6912 @end table
6913
6914 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6915 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6916 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6917 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6918 @c
6919 @c @table @code
6920 @c @item hwbreak
6921 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6922 @c @item swbreak (default)
6923 @c @end table
6924
6925 @subsubsection Data Cache
6926 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6927 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6928 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6929 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6930 registers.
6931
6932 @table @code
6933 @item cache
6934 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6935 @item nocache
6936 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6937 @end table
6938
6939 @subsection Memory Access Checking
6940 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
6941 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
6942 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
6943 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
6944
6945 @table @code
6946 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
6947 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
6948 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
6949 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
6950 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
6951 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
6952 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
6953 The default value is @code{off}.
6954 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
6955 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
6956 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
6957 @end table
6958
6959
6960 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6961 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6962 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6963 @c
6964 @c @table @code
6965 @c @item verify
6966 @c @item noverify (default)
6967 @c @end table
6968
6969 @node Dump/Restore Files
6970 @section Copy between memory and a file
6971 @cindex dump/restore files
6972 @cindex append data to a file
6973 @cindex dump data to a file
6974 @cindex restore data from a file
6975
6976 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6977 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6978 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6979 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6980 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6981 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6982 files.
6983
6984 @table @code
6985
6986 @kindex dump
6987 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6988 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6989 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6990 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6991
6992 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6993 @table @code
6994 @item binary
6995 Raw binary form.
6996 @item ihex
6997 Intel hex format.
6998 @item srec
6999 Motorola S-record format.
7000 @item tekhex
7001 Tektronix Hex format.
7002 @end table
7003
7004 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7005 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7006 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7007 form.
7008
7009 @kindex append
7010 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7011 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7012 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7013 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7014 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7015
7016 @kindex restore
7017 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7018 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7019 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7020 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7021 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7022
7023 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7024 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7025 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7026 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7027 from that location.
7028
7029 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7030 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7031 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7032 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7033
7034 @end table
7035
7036 @node Core File Generation
7037 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7038 @cindex dump core from inferior
7039
7040 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7041 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7042 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7043 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7044 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7045 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7046 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7047
7048 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7049 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7050 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7051
7052 @table @code
7053 @kindex gcore
7054 @kindex generate-core-file
7055 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7056 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7057 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7058 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7059 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7060 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7061
7062 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7063 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7064 @end table
7065
7066 @node Character Sets
7067 @section Character Sets
7068 @cindex character sets
7069 @cindex charset
7070 @cindex translating between character sets
7071 @cindex host character set
7072 @cindex target character set
7073
7074 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7075 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7076 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7077 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7078 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7079 @dfn{target character set}.
7080
7081 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7082 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7083 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7084 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7085 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7086 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7087 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7088 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7089 character and string literals in expressions.
7090
7091 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7092 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7093 target-charset} command, described below.
7094
7095 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7096 support:
7097
7098 @table @code
7099 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7100 @kindex set target-charset
7101 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7102 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7103 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7104 list the target character sets it supports.
7105 @end table
7106
7107 @table @code
7108 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7109 @kindex set host-charset
7110 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7111
7112 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7113 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7114 @code{set host-charset} command.
7115
7116 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7117 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7118 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7119 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7120 list the host character sets it supports.
7121
7122 @item set charset @var{charset}
7123 @kindex set charset
7124 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7125 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7126 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7127 for both host and target.
7128
7129
7130 @item show charset
7131 @kindex show charset
7132 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7133
7134 @itemx show host-charset
7135 @kindex show host-charset
7136 Show the name of the current host charset.
7137
7138 @itemx show target-charset
7139 @kindex show target-charset
7140 Show the name of the current target charset.
7141
7142 @end table
7143
7144 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7145 sets:
7146
7147 @table @code
7148
7149 @item ASCII
7150 @cindex ASCII character set
7151 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7152 character set.
7153
7154 @item ISO-8859-1
7155 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7156 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7157 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7158 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7159 this as its host character set.
7160
7161 @item EBCDIC-US
7162 @itemx IBM1047
7163 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7164 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7165 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7166 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7167 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7168
7169 @end table
7170
7171 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7172 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7173 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7174
7175 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7176 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7177 @file{charset-test.c}:
7178
7179 @smallexample
7180 #include <stdio.h>
7181
7182 char ascii_hello[]
7183 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7184 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7185 char ibm1047_hello[]
7186 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7187 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7188
7189 main ()
7190 @{
7191 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7192 @}
7193 @end smallexample
7194
7195 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7196 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7197 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7198
7199 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7200
7201 @smallexample
7202 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7203 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7204 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7205 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7206 @dots{}
7207 (@value{GDBP})
7208 @end smallexample
7209
7210 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7211 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7212 strings:
7213
7214 @smallexample
7215 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7216 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7217 (@value{GDBP})
7218 @end smallexample
7219
7220 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7221 initial character set:
7222 @smallexample
7223 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7224 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7225 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7226 (@value{GDBP})
7227 @end smallexample
7228
7229 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7230 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7231 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7232 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7233 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7234
7235 @smallexample
7236 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7237 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7238 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7239 $2 = 72 'H'
7240 (@value{GDBP})
7241 @end smallexample
7242
7243 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7244 literals you use in expressions:
7245
7246 @smallexample
7247 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7248 $3 = 43 '+'
7249 (@value{GDBP})
7250 @end smallexample
7251
7252 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7253 character.
7254
7255 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7256 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7257 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7258
7259 @smallexample
7260 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7261 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7262 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7263 $5 = 200 '\310'
7264 (@value{GDBP})
7265 @end smallexample
7266
7267 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7268 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7269
7270 @smallexample
7271 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7272 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7273 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7274 @end smallexample
7275
7276 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7277 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7278 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7279 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7280 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7281
7282 @smallexample
7283 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7284 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7285 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7286 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7287 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7288 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7289 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7290 $7 = 72 '\110'
7291 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7292 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7293 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7294 $9 = 200 'H'
7295 (@value{GDBP})
7296 @end smallexample
7297
7298 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7299 string literals you use in expressions:
7300
7301 @smallexample
7302 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7303 $10 = 78 '+'
7304 (@value{GDBP})
7305 @end smallexample
7306
7307 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7308 character.
7309
7310 @node Caching Remote Data
7311 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7312 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7313
7314 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7315 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
7316 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7317 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7318 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7319 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7320 volatile registers are in use.
7321
7322 @table @code
7323 @kindex set remotecache
7324 @item set remotecache on
7325 @itemx set remotecache off
7326 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7327 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7328
7329 @kindex show remotecache
7330 @item show remotecache
7331 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7332
7333 @kindex info dcache
7334 @item info dcache
7335 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7336 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7337 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7338 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7339 the data cache operation.
7340 @end table
7341
7342
7343 @node Macros
7344 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7345
7346 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7347 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7348 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7349 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7350 where it was defined.
7351
7352 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7353 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7354 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7355 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7356
7357 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7358 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7359 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7360 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7361 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7362 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7363 see @ref{List}.
7364
7365 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7366 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7367 variable-arity macros.
7368
7369 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7370 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7371 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7372
7373 @table @code
7374
7375 @kindex macro expand
7376 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7377 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7378 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7379 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7380 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7381 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7382 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7383 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7384 it can be any string of tokens.
7385
7386 @kindex macro exp1
7387 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7388 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7389 @cindex expand macro once
7390 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7391 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7392 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7393 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7394 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7395 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7396 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7397 can be any string of tokens.
7398
7399 @kindex info macro
7400 @cindex macro definition, showing
7401 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7402 @item info macro @var{macro}
7403 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7404 source location where that definition was established.
7405
7406 @kindex macro define
7407 @cindex user-defined macros
7408 @cindex defining macros interactively
7409 @cindex macros, user-defined
7410 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7411 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7412 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7413 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7414 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7415 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7416 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7417 given in @var{arglist}.
7418
7419 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7420 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7421 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7422 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7423 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7424
7425 @kindex macro undef
7426 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7427 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7428 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7429 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7430 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7431 debugged.
7432
7433 @kindex macro list
7434 @item macro list
7435 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7436 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7437 @end table
7438
7439 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7440 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7441 show our source files:
7442
7443 @smallexample
7444 $ cat sample.c
7445 #include <stdio.h>
7446 #include "sample.h"
7447
7448 #define M 42
7449 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7450
7451 main ()
7452 @{
7453 #define N 28
7454 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7455 #undef N
7456 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7457 #define N 1729
7458 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7459 @}
7460 $ cat sample.h
7461 #define Q <
7462 $
7463 @end smallexample
7464
7465 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7466 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7467 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7468 information.
7469
7470 @smallexample
7471 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7472 $
7473 @end smallexample
7474
7475 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7476
7477 @smallexample
7478 $ gdb -nw sample
7479 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7480 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7481 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7482 (@value{GDBP})
7483 @end smallexample
7484
7485 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7486 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7487 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7488
7489 @smallexample
7490 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7491 3
7492 4 #define M 42
7493 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7494 6
7495 7 main ()
7496 8 @{
7497 9 #define N 28
7498 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7499 11 #undef N
7500 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7501 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7502 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7503 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7504 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7505 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7506 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7507 #define Q <
7508 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7509 expands to: (42 + 1)
7510 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7511 expands to: once (M + 1)
7512 (@value{GDBP})
7513 @end smallexample
7514
7515 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7516 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7517 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7518 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7519
7520 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7521 the source line of the current stack frame:
7522
7523 @smallexample
7524 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7525 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7526 (@value{GDBP}) run
7527 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7528
7529 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7530 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7531 (@value{GDBP})
7532 @end smallexample
7533
7534 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7535
7536 @smallexample
7537 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7538 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7539 #define N 28
7540 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7541 expands to: 28 < 42
7542 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7543 $1 = 1
7544 (@value{GDBP})
7545 @end smallexample
7546
7547 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7548 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7549 thereof) in force at each point:
7550
7551 @smallexample
7552 (@value{GDBP}) next
7553 Hello, world!
7554 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7555 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7556 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7557 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7558 (@value{GDBP}) next
7559 We're so creative.
7560 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7561 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7562 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7563 #define N 1729
7564 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7565 expands to: 1729 < 42
7566 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7567 $2 = 0
7568 (@value{GDBP})
7569 @end smallexample
7570
7571
7572 @node Tracepoints
7573 @chapter Tracepoints
7574 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7575 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7576
7577 @cindex tracepoints
7578 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7579 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7580 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7581 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7582 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7583 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7584 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7585
7586 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7587 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7588 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7589 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7590 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7591 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7592 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7593 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7594 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7595 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7596 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7597
7598 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7599 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7600 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7601 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7602 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7603 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7604 Packets}.
7605
7606 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7607
7608 @menu
7609 * Set Tracepoints::
7610 * Analyze Collected Data::
7611 * Tracepoint Variables::
7612 @end menu
7613
7614 @node Set Tracepoints
7615 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7616
7617 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7618 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7619 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7620 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7621 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7622 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7623 work on.
7624
7625 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7626 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7627 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7628 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7629 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7630 tracepoint was hit.
7631
7632 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7633 conditions and actions.
7634
7635 @menu
7636 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7637 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7638 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7639 * Tracepoint Actions::
7640 * Listing Tracepoints::
7641 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7642 @end menu
7643
7644 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7645 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7646
7647 @table @code
7648 @cindex set tracepoint
7649 @kindex trace
7650 @item trace
7651 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7652 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7653 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7654 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7655 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7656 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7657 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7658 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7659 running.
7660
7661 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7662
7663 @smallexample
7664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7665
7666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7667
7668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7669
7670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7671
7672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7673 @end smallexample
7674
7675 @noindent
7676 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7677
7678 @vindex $tpnum
7679 @cindex last tracepoint number
7680 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7681 @cindex tracepoint number
7682 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7683 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7684
7685 @kindex delete tracepoint
7686 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7687 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7688 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7689 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7690
7691 Examples:
7692
7693 @smallexample
7694 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7695
7696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7697 @end smallexample
7698
7699 @noindent
7700 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7701 @end table
7702
7703 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7704 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7705
7706 @table @code
7707 @kindex disable tracepoint
7708 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7709 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7710 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7711 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7712 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7713
7714 @kindex enable tracepoint
7715 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7716 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7717 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7718 run.
7719 @end table
7720
7721 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7722 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7723
7724 @table @code
7725 @kindex passcount
7726 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7727 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7728 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7729 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7730 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7731 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7732 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7733 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7734 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7735 user.
7736
7737 Examples:
7738
7739 @smallexample
7740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7741 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7742
7743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7744 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7751 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7752 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7753 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7754 @end smallexample
7755 @end table
7756
7757 @node Tracepoint Actions
7758 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7759
7760 @table @code
7761 @kindex actions
7762 @cindex tracepoint actions
7763 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7764 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7765 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7766 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7767 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7768 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7769 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7770 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7771 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7772 @code{while-stepping}.
7773
7774 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7775 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7776 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7777
7778 @smallexample
7779 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7780
7781 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7782
7783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7784 @end smallexample
7785
7786 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7787 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7788 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7789 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7790 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7791 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7792 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7793 @code{end} command.
7794
7795 @smallexample
7796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7797 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7798 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7799 > collect bar,baz
7800 > collect $regs
7801 > while-stepping 12
7802 > collect $fp, $sp
7803 > end
7804 end
7805 @end smallexample
7806
7807 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7808 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7809 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7810 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7811 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7812 special arguments are supported:
7813
7814 @table @code
7815 @item $regs
7816 collect all registers
7817
7818 @item $args
7819 collect all function arguments
7820
7821 @item $locals
7822 collect all local variables.
7823 @end table
7824
7825 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7826 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7827 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7828
7829 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7830 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7831
7832 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7833 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7834 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7835 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7836 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7837 its own @code{end} command):
7838
7839 @smallexample
7840 > while-stepping 12
7841 > collect $regs, myglobal
7842 > end
7843 >
7844 @end smallexample
7845
7846 @noindent
7847 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7848 @code{stepping}.
7849 @end table
7850
7851 @node Listing Tracepoints
7852 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7853
7854 @table @code
7855 @kindex info tracepoints
7856 @kindex info tp
7857 @cindex information about tracepoints
7858 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7859 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7860 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7861 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7862 shown:
7863
7864 @itemize @bullet
7865 @item
7866 its number
7867 @item
7868 whether it is enabled or disabled
7869 @item
7870 its address
7871 @item
7872 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7873 @item
7874 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7875 @item
7876 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7877 @item
7878 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7879 @end itemize
7880
7881 @smallexample
7882 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7883 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7884 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7885 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7886 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7887 (@value{GDBP})
7888 @end smallexample
7889
7890 @noindent
7891 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7892 @end table
7893
7894 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7895 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7896
7897 @table @code
7898 @kindex tstart
7899 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7900 @cindex collected data discarded
7901 @item tstart
7902 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7903 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7904 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7905 experiment.
7906
7907 @kindex tstop
7908 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7909 @item tstop
7910 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7911 stops collecting data.
7912
7913 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7914 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7915 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7916
7917 @kindex tstatus
7918 @cindex status of trace data collection
7919 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7920 @item tstatus
7921 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7922 collection.
7923 @end table
7924
7925 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7926
7927 @smallexample
7928 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7929 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7930 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7931 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7932 > while-stepping 11
7933 > collect $regs
7934 > end
7935 > end
7936 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7937 [time passes @dots{}]
7938 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7939 @end smallexample
7940
7941
7942 @node Analyze Collected Data
7943 @section Using the collected data
7944
7945 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7946 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7947 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7948 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7949 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7950 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7951 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7952 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7953 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7954 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7955 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7956 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7957 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7958 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7959 the buffer will fail.
7960
7961 @menu
7962 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7963 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7964 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7965 @end menu
7966
7967 @node tfind
7968 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7969
7970 @kindex tfind
7971 @cindex select trace snapshot
7972 @cindex find trace snapshot
7973 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7974 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7975 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7976 snapshot is selected.
7977
7978 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7979
7980 @table @code
7981 @item tfind start
7982 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7983 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7984
7985 @item tfind none
7986 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7987
7988 @item tfind end
7989 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7990
7991 @item tfind
7992 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7993
7994 @item tfind -
7995 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7996 retracing earlier steps.
7997
7998 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7999 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8000 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8001 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8002 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8003
8004 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8005 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8006 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8007 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8008 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8009
8010 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8011 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8012 addresses.
8013
8014 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8015 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8016 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8017
8018 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8019 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8020 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8021 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8022 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8023 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8024 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8025 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8026 @end table
8027
8028 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8029 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8030 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8031 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8032 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8033 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8034 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8035 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8036 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8037 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8038 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8039 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8040 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8041 tracepoint as the current one.
8042
8043 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8044 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8045 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8046 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8047 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8048
8049 @smallexample
8050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8051 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8052 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8053 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8054 > tfind
8055 > end
8056
8057 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8058 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8059 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8060 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8061 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8062 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8063 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8064 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8065 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8066 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8067 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8068 @end smallexample
8069
8070 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8071 the buffer:
8072
8073 @smallexample
8074 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8075 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8076 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8077 > tfind line
8078 > end
8079
8080 Frame 0, X = 1
8081 Frame 7, X = 2
8082 Frame 13, X = 255
8083 @end smallexample
8084
8085 @node tdump
8086 @subsection @code{tdump}
8087 @kindex tdump
8088 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8089 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8090
8091 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8092 the current trace snapshot.
8093
8094 @smallexample
8095 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8096 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8097 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8098 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8099 > end
8100
8101 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8102
8103 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8104 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8105 at gdb_test.c:444
8106 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8107
8108 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8109 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8110 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8111 d1 0x18 24
8112 d2 0x80 128
8113 d3 0x33 51
8114 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8115 d5 0x22 34
8116 d6 0xe0 224
8117 d7 0x380035 3670069
8118 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8119 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8120 a2 0x100 256
8121 a3 0x322000 3284992
8122 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8123 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8124 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8125 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8126 ps 0x0 0
8127 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8128 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8129 fpstatus 0x0 0
8130 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8131 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8132 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8133 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8134 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8135 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8136 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8137 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8138 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8139
8140 (@value{GDBP})
8141 @end smallexample
8142
8143 @node save-tracepoints
8144 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8145 @kindex save-tracepoints
8146 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8147
8148 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8149 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8150 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8151 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8152 Files}).
8153
8154 @node Tracepoint Variables
8155 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8156 @cindex tracepoint variables
8157 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8158
8159 @table @code
8160 @vindex $trace_frame
8161 @item (int) $trace_frame
8162 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8163 snapshot is selected.
8164
8165 @vindex $tracepoint
8166 @item (int) $tracepoint
8167 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8168
8169 @vindex $trace_line
8170 @item (int) $trace_line
8171 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8172
8173 @vindex $trace_file
8174 @item (char []) $trace_file
8175 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8176
8177 @vindex $trace_func
8178 @item (char []) $trace_func
8179 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8180 @end table
8181
8182 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8183 use @code{output} instead.
8184
8185 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8186 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8187 data.
8188
8189 @smallexample
8190 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8191
8192 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8193 > output $trace_file
8194 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8195 > tfind
8196 > end
8197 @end smallexample
8198
8199 @node Overlays
8200 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8201 @cindex overlays
8202
8203 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8204 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8205 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8206 use overlays.
8207
8208 @menu
8209 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8210 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8211 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8212 mapped by asking the inferior.
8213 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8214 @end menu
8215
8216 @node How Overlays Work
8217 @section How Overlays Work
8218 @cindex mapped overlays
8219 @cindex unmapped overlays
8220 @cindex load address, overlay's
8221 @cindex mapped address
8222 @cindex overlay area
8223
8224 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8225 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8226 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8227 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8228 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8229
8230 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8231 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8232 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8233 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8234 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8235 largest overlay as well.
8236
8237 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8238 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8239 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8240 there.
8241
8242 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8243 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8244 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8245
8246 @smallexample
8247 @group
8248 Data Instruction Larger
8249 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8250 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8251 | | | | | |
8252 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8253 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8254 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8255 | and heap | | | | | |
8256 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8257 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8258 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8259 | | | | | |
8260 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8261 address | | | | | |
8262 | overlay | <-' | | |
8263 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8264 | | <---. | | load address
8265 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8266 | | | |
8267 +-----------+ | |
8268 +-----------+
8269 | |
8270 +-----------+
8271
8272 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8273 @end group
8274 @end smallexample
8275
8276 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8277 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8278 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8279 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8280 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8281 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8282 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8283 program and the overlay area.
8284
8285 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8286 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8287 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8288 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8289 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8290 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8291 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8292
8293 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8294 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8295 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8296
8297 @itemize @bullet
8298
8299 @item
8300 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8301 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8302 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8303 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8304
8305 @item
8306 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8307 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8308 your program's performance.
8309
8310 @item
8311 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8312 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8313 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8314 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8315 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8316 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8317 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8318
8319 @item
8320 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8321 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8322 instruction and data spaces.
8323
8324 @end itemize
8325
8326 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8327 improved in many ways:
8328
8329 @itemize @bullet
8330
8331 @item
8332 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8333 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8334 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8335 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8336 area in the usual way.
8337
8338 @item
8339 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8340 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8341
8342 @item
8343 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8344 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8345 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8346 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8347 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8348 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8349 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8350
8351 @end itemize
8352
8353
8354 @node Overlay Commands
8355 @section Overlay Commands
8356
8357 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8358 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8359 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8360 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8361 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8362 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8363
8364 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8365 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8366
8367 @table @code
8368 @item overlay off
8369 @kindex overlay
8370 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8371 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8372 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8373 overlay support is disabled.
8374
8375 @item overlay manual
8376 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8377 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8378 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8379 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8380 commands described below.
8381
8382 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8383 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8384 @cindex map an overlay
8385 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8386 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8387 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8388 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8389 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8390 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8391
8392 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8393 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8394 @cindex unmap an overlay
8395 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8396 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8397 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8398 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8399
8400 @item overlay auto
8401 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8402 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8403 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8404 Overlay Debugging}.
8405
8406 @item overlay load-target
8407 @itemx overlay load
8408 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8409 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8410 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8411 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8412 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8413 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8414
8415 @item overlay list-overlays
8416 @itemx overlay list
8417 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8418 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8419 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8420
8421 @end table
8422
8423 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8424 of the function the address falls in:
8425
8426 @smallexample
8427 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8428 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8429 @end smallexample
8430 @noindent
8431 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8432 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8433 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8434 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8435
8436 @smallexample
8437 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8438 No sections are mapped.
8439 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8440 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8441 @end smallexample
8442 @noindent
8443 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8444 name normally:
8445
8446 @smallexample
8447 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8448 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8449 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8450 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8451 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8452 @end smallexample
8453
8454 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8455 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8456 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8457 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8458 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8459
8460 @itemize @bullet
8461 @item
8462 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8463 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8464 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8465 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8466 @item
8467 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8468 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8469 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8470 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8471 breakpoints properly.
8472 @end itemize
8473
8474
8475 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8476 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8477 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8478
8479 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8480 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8481 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8482 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8483 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8484 current state of the overlays.
8485
8486 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8487 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8488
8489 @table @asis
8490
8491 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8492 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8493
8494 @smallexample
8495 struct
8496 @{
8497 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8498 unsigned long vma;
8499
8500 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8501 unsigned long size;
8502
8503 /* The overlay's load address. */
8504 unsigned long lma;
8505
8506 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8507 zero otherwise. */
8508 unsigned long mapped;
8509 @}
8510 @end smallexample
8511
8512 @item @code{_novlys}:
8513 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8514 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8515
8516 @end table
8517
8518 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8519 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8520 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8521 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8522 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8523 currently mapped.
8524
8525 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8526 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8527 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8528 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8529 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8530 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8531 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8532 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8533 are not being executed.
8534
8535 @node Overlay Sample Program
8536 @section Overlay Sample Program
8537 @cindex overlay example program
8538
8539 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8540 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8541 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8542 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8543 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8544 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8545 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8546
8547 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8548 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8549 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8550 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8551
8552 @table @file
8553 @item overlays.c
8554 The main program file.
8555 @item ovlymgr.c
8556 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8557 @item foo.c
8558 @itemx bar.c
8559 @itemx baz.c
8560 @itemx grbx.c
8561 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8562 @item d10v.ld
8563 @itemx m32r.ld
8564 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8565 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8566 @end table
8567
8568 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8569 cross-compiler like this:
8570
8571 @smallexample
8572 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8573 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8574 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8575 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8576 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8577 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8578 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8579 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8580 @end smallexample
8581
8582 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8583 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8584 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8585
8586
8587 @node Languages
8588 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8589 @cindex languages
8590
8591 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8592 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8593 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8594 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8595 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8596 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8597
8598 @cindex working language
8599 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8600 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8601 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8602 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8603 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8604 language}.
8605
8606 @menu
8607 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8608 * Show:: Displaying the language
8609 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8610 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8611 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8612 @end menu
8613
8614 @node Setting
8615 @section Switching between source languages
8616
8617 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8618 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8619 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8620 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8621 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8622 are printed, etc.
8623
8624 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8625 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8626 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8627 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8628 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8629 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8630 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8631 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8632 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8633 Displaying the language}.
8634
8635 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8636 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8637 another language. In that case, make the
8638 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8639 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8640 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8641
8642 @menu
8643 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8644 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8645 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8646 @end menu
8647
8648 @node Filenames
8649 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8650
8651 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8652 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8653
8654 @table @file
8655 @item .ada
8656 @itemx .ads
8657 @itemx .adb
8658 @itemx .a
8659 Ada source file.
8660
8661 @item .c
8662 C source file
8663
8664 @item .C
8665 @itemx .cc
8666 @itemx .cp
8667 @itemx .cpp
8668 @itemx .cxx
8669 @itemx .c++
8670 C@t{++} source file
8671
8672 @item .m
8673 Objective-C source file
8674
8675 @item .f
8676 @itemx .F
8677 Fortran source file
8678
8679 @item .mod
8680 Modula-2 source file
8681
8682 @item .s
8683 @itemx .S
8684 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8685 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8686 @end table
8687
8688 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8689 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8690
8691 @node Manually
8692 @subsection Setting the working language
8693
8694 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8695 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8696 your program.
8697
8698 @kindex set language
8699 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8700 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8701 a language, such as
8702 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8703 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8704
8705 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8706 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8707 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8708 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8709 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8710 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8711 command such as:
8712
8713 @smallexample
8714 print a = b + c
8715 @end smallexample
8716
8717 @noindent
8718 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8719 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8720 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8721 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8722
8723 @node Automatically
8724 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8725
8726 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8727 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8728 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8729 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8730 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8731 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8732 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8733 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8734 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8735
8736 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8737 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8738 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8739 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8740 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8741
8742 @node Show
8743 @section Displaying the language
8744
8745 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8746 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8747
8748 @table @code
8749 @item show language
8750 @kindex show language
8751 Display the current working language. This is the
8752 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8753 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8754
8755 @item info frame
8756 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8757 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8758 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8759 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8760 information listed here.
8761
8762 @item info source
8763 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8764 Display the source language of this source file.
8765 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8766 information listed here.
8767 @end table
8768
8769 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8770 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8771 with a language explicitly:
8772
8773 @table @code
8774 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8775 @kindex set extension-language
8776 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8777 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8778
8779 @item info extensions
8780 @kindex info extensions
8781 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8782 @end table
8783
8784 @node Checks
8785 @section Type and range checking
8786
8787 @quotation
8788 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8789 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8790 section documents the intended facilities.
8791 @end quotation
8792 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8793
8794 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8795 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8796 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8797 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8798 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8799 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8800 errors when your program is running.
8801
8802 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8803 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8804 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8805 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8806 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8807 automatically based on your program's source language.
8808 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8809 settings of supported languages.
8810
8811 @menu
8812 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8813 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8814 @end menu
8815
8816 @cindex type checking
8817 @cindex checks, type
8818 @node Type Checking
8819 @subsection An overview of type checking
8820
8821 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8822 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8823 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8824 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8825
8826 @smallexample
8827 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8828 @exdent but
8829 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8830 @end smallexample
8831
8832 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8833 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8834
8835 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8836 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8837 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8838 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8839 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8840 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8841 also issues a warning.
8842
8843 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8844 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8845 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8846 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8847 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8848 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8849
8850 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8851 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8852 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8853 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8854 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8855 details on specific languages.
8856
8857 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8858
8859 @kindex set check type
8860 @kindex show check type
8861 @table @code
8862 @item set check type auto
8863 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8864 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8865 each language.
8866
8867 @item set check type on
8868 @itemx set check type off
8869 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8870 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8871 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8872 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8873 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8874
8875 @item set check type warn
8876 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8877 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8878 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8879 numbers and structures.
8880
8881 @item show type
8882 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8883 is setting it automatically.
8884 @end table
8885
8886 @cindex range checking
8887 @cindex checks, range
8888 @node Range Checking
8889 @subsection An overview of range checking
8890
8891 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8892 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8893 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8894 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8895 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8896
8897 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8898 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8899 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8900 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8901
8902 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8903 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8904 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8905 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8906 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8907 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8908
8909 @smallexample
8910 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8911 @end smallexample
8912
8913 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8914 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8915 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8916
8917 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8918
8919 @kindex set check range
8920 @kindex show check range
8921 @table @code
8922 @item set check range auto
8923 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8924 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8925 each language.
8926
8927 @item set check range on
8928 @itemx set check range off
8929 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8930 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8931 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8932 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8933
8934 @item set check range warn
8935 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8936 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8937 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8938 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8939 systems).
8940
8941 @item show range
8942 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8943 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8944 @end table
8945
8946 @node Supported languages
8947 @section Supported languages
8948
8949 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8950 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8951 @c This is false ...
8952 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8953 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8954 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8955 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8956 language.
8957
8958 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8959 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8960 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8961 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8962 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8963 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8964 language reference or tutorial.
8965
8966 @menu
8967 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8968 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8969 * Fortran:: Fortran
8970 * Pascal:: Pascal
8971 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8972 * Ada:: Ada
8973 @end menu
8974
8975 @node C
8976 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8977
8978 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8979 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8980
8981 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8982 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8983 together.
8984
8985 @cindex C@t{++}
8986 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8987 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8988 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8989 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8990 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8991 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8992 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8993
8994 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8995 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8996 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8997 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8998 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8999 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
9000
9001 @menu
9002 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9003 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9004 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9005 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9006 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9007 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9008 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9009 @end menu
9010
9011 @node C Operators
9012 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
9013
9014 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9015
9016 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9017 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9018 often defined on groups of types.
9019
9020 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9021
9022 @itemize @bullet
9023
9024 @item
9025 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9026 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9027
9028 @item
9029 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9030 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9031
9032 @item
9033 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9034
9035 @item
9036 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9037
9038 @end itemize
9039
9040 @noindent
9041 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9042 in order of increasing precedence:
9043
9044 @table @code
9045 @item ,
9046 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9047 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9048 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9049
9050 @item =
9051 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9052 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9053
9054 @item @var{op}=
9055 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9056 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9057 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9058 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9059 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9060
9061 @item ?:
9062 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9063 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9064 integral type.
9065
9066 @item ||
9067 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9068
9069 @item &&
9070 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9071
9072 @item |
9073 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9074
9075 @item ^
9076 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9077
9078 @item &
9079 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9080
9081 @item ==@r{, }!=
9082 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9083 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9084
9085 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9086 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9087 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9088 and non-zero for true.
9089
9090 @item <<@r{, }>>
9091 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9092
9093 @item @@
9094 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9095
9096 @item +@r{, }-
9097 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9098 pointer types.
9099
9100 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9101 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9102 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9103 integral types.
9104
9105 @item ++@r{, }--
9106 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9107 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9108 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9109 operation takes place.
9110
9111 @item *
9112 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9113 @code{++}.
9114
9115 @item &
9116 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9117
9118 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9119 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9120 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9121 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9122 stored.
9123
9124 @item -
9125 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9126 precedence as @code{++}.
9127
9128 @item !
9129 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9130 @code{++}.
9131
9132 @item ~
9133 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9134 @code{++}.
9135
9136
9137 @item .@r{, }->
9138 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9139 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9140 pointer based on the stored type information.
9141 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9142
9143 @item .*@r{, }->*
9144 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9145
9146 @item []
9147 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9148 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9149
9150 @item ()
9151 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9152
9153 @item ::
9154 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9155 and @code{class} types.
9156
9157 @item ::
9158 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9159 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9160 above.
9161 @end table
9162
9163 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9164 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9165 predefined meaning.
9166
9167 @menu
9168 * C Constants::
9169 @end menu
9170
9171 @node C Constants
9172 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
9173
9174 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9175
9176 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9177 following ways:
9178
9179 @itemize @bullet
9180 @item
9181 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9182 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9183 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9184 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9185 @code{long} value.
9186
9187 @item
9188 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9189 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9190 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9191 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9192 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9193 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9194 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9195 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9196 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9197 constant.
9198
9199 @item
9200 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9201 integral equivalents.
9202
9203 @item
9204 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9205 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9206 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9207 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9208 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9209 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9210 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9211 @samp{\n} for newline.
9212
9213 @item
9214 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9215 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9216 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9217 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9218 characters.
9219
9220 @item
9221 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9222 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9223
9224 @item
9225 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9226 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9227 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9228 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9229 @end itemize
9230
9231 @menu
9232 * C plus plus expressions::
9233 * C Defaults::
9234 * C Checks::
9235
9236 * Debugging C::
9237 @end menu
9238
9239 @node C plus plus expressions
9240 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
9241
9242 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9243 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9244
9245 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9246 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9247 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9248 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9249 @quotation
9250 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9251 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9252 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9253 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9254 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9255 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9256 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9257 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9258 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9259 C@t{++} code.
9260 @end quotation
9261
9262 @enumerate
9263
9264 @cindex member functions
9265 @item
9266 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9267
9268 @smallexample
9269 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9270 @end smallexample
9271
9272 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9273 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9274 @item
9275 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9276 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9277 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9278 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9279
9280 @cindex call overloaded functions
9281 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9282 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9283 @item
9284 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9285 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9286 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9287 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9288 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9289 default arguments.
9290
9291 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9292 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9293 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9294 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9295 number of function arguments.
9296
9297 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9298 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
9299 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
9300
9301 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9302 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9303 @smallexample
9304 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9305 @end smallexample
9306
9307 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9308 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
9309
9310 @cindex reference declarations
9311 @item
9312 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9313 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9314 dereferenced.
9315
9316 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9317 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9318 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9319 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9320 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9321
9322 @item
9323 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9324 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9325 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9326 necessary, for example in an expression like
9327 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9328 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9329 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
9330 @end enumerate
9331
9332 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9333 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9334 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9335 invoking user-defined operators.
9336
9337 @node C Defaults
9338 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
9339
9340 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9341
9342 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9343 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9344 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9345 selects the working language.
9346
9347 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9348 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9349 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9350 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9351 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
9352 for further details.
9353
9354 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9355 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9356 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9357
9358 @node C Checks
9359 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9360
9361 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9362
9363 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9364 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9365 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9366
9367 @itemize @bullet
9368 @item
9369 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9370 enumerated tag.
9371
9372 @item
9373 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9374 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9375
9376 @ignore
9377 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9378 @c FIXME--beers?
9379 @item
9380 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9381 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9382 compilers.)
9383 @end ignore
9384 @end itemize
9385
9386 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9387 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9388 that is not itself an array.
9389
9390 @node Debugging C
9391 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9392
9393 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9394 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9395 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9396 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9397
9398 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9399 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9400 ,Expressions}.
9401
9402 @menu
9403 * Debugging C plus plus::
9404 @end menu
9405
9406 @node Debugging C plus plus
9407 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9408
9409 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9410
9411 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9412 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9413
9414 @table @code
9415 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9416 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9417 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9418 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9419 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
9420
9421 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9422 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9423 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9424 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9425 classes.
9426 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
9427
9428 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9429 @item catch throw
9430 @itemx catch catch
9431 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9432 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
9433
9434 @cindex inheritance
9435 @item ptype @var{typename}
9436 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9437 @var{typename}.
9438 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9439
9440 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9441 @item set print demangle
9442 @itemx show print demangle
9443 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9444 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9445 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9446 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9447 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9448
9449 @item set print object
9450 @itemx show print object
9451 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9452 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9453
9454 @item set print vtbl
9455 @itemx show print vtbl
9456 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9457 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9458 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9459 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9460
9461 @kindex set overload-resolution
9462 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9463 @item set overload-resolution on
9464 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9465 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9466 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9467 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
9468 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
9469 message.
9470
9471 @item set overload-resolution off
9472 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9473 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9474 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9475 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9476 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9477 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9478 argument types.
9479
9480 @kindex show overload-resolution
9481 @item show overload-resolution
9482 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9483
9484 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9485 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9486 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9487 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9488 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9489 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9490 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9491 @end table
9492
9493 @node Objective-C
9494 @subsection Objective-C
9495
9496 @cindex Objective-C
9497 This section provides information about some commands and command
9498 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9499 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9500 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9501
9502 @menu
9503 * Method Names in Commands::
9504 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9505 @end menu
9506
9507 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
9508 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9509
9510 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9511 names as line specifications:
9512
9513 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9514 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9515 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9516 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9517 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9518 @itemize
9519 @item @code{clear}
9520 @item @code{break}
9521 @item @code{info line}
9522 @item @code{jump}
9523 @item @code{list}
9524 @end itemize
9525
9526 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9527
9528 @smallexample
9529 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9530 @end smallexample
9531
9532 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9533 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9534 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9535 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9536 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9537 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9538 debugged, enter:
9539
9540 @smallexample
9541 break -[Fruit create]
9542 @end smallexample
9543
9544 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9545 enter:
9546
9547 @smallexample
9548 list +[NSText initialize]
9549 @end smallexample
9550
9551 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9552 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9553 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9554 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9555
9556 @smallexample
9557 break create
9558 @end smallexample
9559
9560 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9561 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9562 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9563 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9564 none apply.
9565
9566 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9567 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9568
9569 @smallexample
9570 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9571 @end smallexample
9572
9573 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9574 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9575 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9576 @kindex print-object
9577 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9578
9579 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9580
9581 @smallexample
9582 print -[@var{object} hash]
9583 @end smallexample
9584
9585 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9586 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9587 @noindent
9588 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9589 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9590 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9591 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9592 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9593 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9594
9595 @node Fortran
9596 @subsection Fortran
9597 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9598
9599 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9600 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9601
9602 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9603 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9604 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9605 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9606 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9607 underscore.
9608
9609 @menu
9610 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9611 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9612 * Special Fortran commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9613 @end menu
9614
9615 @node Fortran Operators
9616 @subsubsection Fortran operators and expressions
9617
9618 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9619
9620 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9621 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9622 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9623
9624 @table @code
9625 @item **
9626 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9627 of the second one.
9628
9629 @item :
9630 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9631 represent a section of array.
9632 @end table
9633
9634 @node Fortran Defaults
9635 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9636
9637 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9638
9639 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9640 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9641 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9642 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9643
9644 @node Special Fortran commands
9645 @subsubsection Special Fortran commands
9646
9647 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9648
9649 @value{GDBN} had some commands to support Fortran specific feature,
9650 such as common block displaying.
9651
9652 @table @code
9653 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9654 @kindex info common
9655 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9656 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9657 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9658 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at current program location are
9659 printed.
9660 @end table
9661
9662 @node Pascal
9663 @subsection Pascal
9664
9665 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9666 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9667 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9668 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9669 syntax.
9670
9671 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9672 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9673 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9674
9675 @node Modula-2
9676 @subsection Modula-2
9677
9678 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9679
9680 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9681 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9682 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9683 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9684 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9685 table.
9686
9687 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9688 @menu
9689 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9690 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9691 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9692 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9693 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9694 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9695 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9696 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9697 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9698 @end menu
9699
9700 @node M2 Operators
9701 @subsubsection Operators
9702 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9703
9704 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9705 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9706 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9707 following definitions hold:
9708
9709 @itemize @bullet
9710
9711 @item
9712 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9713 their subranges.
9714
9715 @item
9716 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9717
9718 @item
9719 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9720
9721 @item
9722 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9723 @var{type}}.
9724
9725 @item
9726 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9727
9728 @item
9729 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9730
9731 @item
9732 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9733 @end itemize
9734
9735 @noindent
9736 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9737 increasing precedence:
9738
9739 @table @code
9740 @item ,
9741 Function argument or array index separator.
9742
9743 @item :=
9744 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9745 @var{value}.
9746
9747 @item <@r{, }>
9748 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9749 types.
9750
9751 @item <=@r{, }>=
9752 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9753 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9754 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9755
9756 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9757 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9758 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9759 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9760 comment character.
9761
9762 @item IN
9763 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9764 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9765
9766 @item OR
9767 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9768
9769 @item AND@r{, }&
9770 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9771
9772 @item @@
9773 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9774
9775 @item +@r{, }-
9776 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9777 and difference on set types.
9778
9779 @item *
9780 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9781 on set types.
9782
9783 @item /
9784 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9785 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9786
9787 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9788 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9789 precedence as @code{*}.
9790
9791 @item -
9792 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9793
9794 @item ^
9795 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9796
9797 @item NOT
9798 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9799 @code{^}.
9800
9801 @item .
9802 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9803 precedence as @code{^}.
9804
9805 @item []
9806 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9807
9808 @item ()
9809 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9810 as @code{^}.
9811
9812 @item ::@r{, }.
9813 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9814 @end table
9815
9816 @quotation
9817 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9818 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9819 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9820 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9821 @end quotation
9822
9823
9824 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9825 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9826 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9827
9828 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9829 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9830
9831 @table @var
9832
9833 @item a
9834 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9835
9836 @item c
9837 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9838
9839 @item i
9840 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9841
9842 @item m
9843 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9844 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9845 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9846
9847 @item n
9848 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9849
9850 @item r
9851 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9852
9853 @item t
9854 represents a type.
9855
9856 @item v
9857 represents a variable.
9858
9859 @item x
9860 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9861 explanation of the function for details.
9862 @end table
9863
9864 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9865
9866 @table @code
9867 @item ABS(@var{n})
9868 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9869
9870 @item CAP(@var{c})
9871 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9872 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9873
9874 @item CHR(@var{i})
9875 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9876
9877 @item DEC(@var{v})
9878 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9879
9880 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9881 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9882 new value.
9883
9884 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9885 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9886 set.
9887
9888 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9889 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9890
9891 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9892 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9893
9894 @item INC(@var{v})
9895 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9896
9897 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9898 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9899 new value.
9900
9901 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9902 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9903 there. Returns the new set.
9904
9905 @item MAX(@var{t})
9906 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9907
9908 @item MIN(@var{t})
9909 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9910
9911 @item ODD(@var{i})
9912 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9913
9914 @item ORD(@var{x})
9915 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9916 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9917 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9918 integral, character and enumerated types.
9919
9920 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9921 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9922
9923 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9924 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9925
9926 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9927 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9928 @end table
9929
9930 @quotation
9931 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9932 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9933 an error.
9934 @end quotation
9935
9936 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9937 @node M2 Constants
9938 @subsubsection Constants
9939
9940 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9941 ways:
9942
9943 @itemize @bullet
9944
9945 @item
9946 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9947 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9948 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9949 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9950
9951 @item
9952 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9953 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9954 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9955 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9956 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9957 digits.
9958
9959 @item
9960 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9961 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9962 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9963 followed by a @samp{C}.
9964
9965 @item
9966 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9967 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9968 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9969 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9970 sequences.
9971
9972 @item
9973 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9974
9975 @item
9976 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9977 @code{FALSE}.
9978
9979 @item
9980 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9981
9982 @item
9983 Set constants are not yet supported.
9984 @end itemize
9985
9986 @node M2 Types
9987 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9988 @cindex Modula-2 types
9989
9990 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9991 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9992 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9993 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9994 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9995 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9996
9997 The first example contains the following section of code:
9998
9999 @smallexample
10000 VAR
10001 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10002 r: [20..40] ;
10003 @end smallexample
10004
10005 @noindent
10006 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10007 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10008
10009 @smallexample
10010 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10011 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10012 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10013 SET OF CHAR
10014 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10015 21
10016 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10017 [20..40]
10018 @end smallexample
10019
10020 @noindent
10021 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10022
10023 @smallexample
10024 VAR
10025 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10026 @end smallexample
10027
10028 @noindent
10029 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10030
10031 @smallexample
10032 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10033 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10034 @end smallexample
10035
10036 @noindent
10037 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10038 expressions using the debugger.
10039
10040 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10041 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10042
10043 @smallexample
10044 VAR
10045 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10046 @end smallexample
10047
10048 @smallexample
10049 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10050 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10051 @end smallexample
10052
10053 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10054 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10055 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10056 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
10057
10058 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10059
10060 @smallexample
10061 TYPE
10062 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10063 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10064 VAR
10065 s: t ;
10066 BEGIN
10067 s := blue ;
10068 @end smallexample
10069
10070 @noindent
10071 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10072 and value of a variable.
10073
10074 @smallexample
10075 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10076 $1 = blue
10077 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10078 type = [blue..yellow]
10079 @end smallexample
10080
10081 @noindent
10082 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10083 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10084 their @code{C} counterparts.
10085
10086 @smallexample
10087 VAR
10088 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10089 BEGIN
10090 s[1] := 1 ;
10091 @end smallexample
10092
10093 @smallexample
10094 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10095 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10096 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10097 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10098 @end smallexample
10099
10100 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10101 pointer types as shown in this example:
10102
10103 @smallexample
10104 VAR
10105 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10106 BEGIN
10107 NEW(s) ;
10108 s^[1] := 1 ;
10109 @end smallexample
10110
10111 @noindent
10112 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10113
10114 @smallexample
10115 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10116 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10117 @end smallexample
10118
10119 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10120 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10121 types:
10122
10123 @smallexample
10124 TYPE
10125 foo = RECORD
10126 f1: CARDINAL ;
10127 f2: CHAR ;
10128 f3: myarray ;
10129 END ;
10130
10131 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10132 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10133 VAR
10134 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10135 @end smallexample
10136
10137 @noindent
10138 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10139 below.
10140
10141 @smallexample
10142 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10143 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10144 f1 : CARDINAL;
10145 f2 : CHAR;
10146 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10147 END
10148 @end smallexample
10149
10150 @node M2 Defaults
10151 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
10152 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10153
10154 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10155 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10156 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10157 selected the working language.
10158
10159 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10160 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10161 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
10162 the language automatically}, for further details.
10163
10164 @node Deviations
10165 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
10166 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10167
10168 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10169 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10170
10171 @itemize @bullet
10172 @item
10173 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10174 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10175 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10176 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10177 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10178 returned a pointer.)
10179
10180 @item
10181 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10182 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10183 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10184 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10185
10186 @item
10187 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10188 argument.
10189
10190 @item
10191 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10192 @end itemize
10193
10194 @node M2 Checks
10195 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
10196 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10197
10198 @quotation
10199 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10200 range checking.
10201 @end quotation
10202 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10203
10204 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10205
10206 @itemize @bullet
10207 @item
10208 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10209 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10210
10211 @item
10212 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10213 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10214 @end itemize
10215
10216 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10217 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10218
10219 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10220 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10221
10222 @node M2 Scope
10223 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10224 @cindex scope
10225 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10226 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10227 @ifinfo
10228 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10229 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10230 @end ifinfo
10231 @iftex
10232 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10233 @end iftex
10234
10235 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10236 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10237 similar syntax:
10238
10239 @smallexample
10240
10241 @var{module} . @var{id}
10242 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10243 @end smallexample
10244
10245 @noindent
10246 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10247 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10248 identifier within your program, except another module.
10249
10250 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10251 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10252 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10253 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10254
10255 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10256 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10257 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10258 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10259 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10260 @var{module}.
10261
10262 @node GDB/M2
10263 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10264
10265 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10266 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10267 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10268 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10269 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10270 analogue in Modula-2.
10271
10272 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10273 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10274 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10275 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10276 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10277 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10278
10279 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10280 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10281 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10282
10283 @node Ada
10284 @subsection Ada
10285 @cindex Ada
10286
10287 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10288 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10289 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10290 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10291 to be difficult.
10292
10293
10294 @cindex expressions in Ada
10295 @menu
10296 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10297 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10298 in @value{GDBN}.
10299 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10300 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10301 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10302 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10303 @end menu
10304
10305 @node Ada Mode Intro
10306 @subsubsection Introduction
10307 @cindex Ada mode, general
10308
10309 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10310 syntax, with some extensions.
10311 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10312
10313 @itemize @bullet
10314 @item
10315 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10316 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10317 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10318 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10319
10320 @item
10321 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10322 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10323
10324 @item
10325 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10326 @end itemize
10327
10328 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10329 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10330 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10331 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10332 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10333
10334 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10335 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10336 was translated from an Ada source file.
10337
10338 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10339 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10340 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10341 middle (to allow based literals).
10342
10343 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10344 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10345 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10346 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10347 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10348 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10349
10350 @node Omissions from Ada
10351 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10352 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10353
10354 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10355
10356 @itemize @bullet
10357 @item
10358 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10359
10360 @itemize @minus
10361 @item
10362 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10363 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10364
10365 @item
10366 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10367
10368 @item
10369 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10370
10371 @item
10372 @t{'Tag}.
10373
10374 @item
10375 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10376 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10377
10378 @item
10379 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10380 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10381
10382 @item
10383 @t{'Address}.
10384 @end itemize
10385
10386 @item
10387 The names in
10388 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10389 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10390 not currently available.
10391
10392 @item
10393 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10394 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10395 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10396 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10397 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10398 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10399 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10400 indeterminate values.
10401
10402 @item
10403 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10404 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10405 are not implemented.
10406
10407 @item
10408 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10409 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10410 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10411 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10412 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10413
10414 @smallexample
10415 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10416 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10417 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10418 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10419 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10420 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10421 @end smallexample
10422
10423 Changing a
10424 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10425 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10426 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10427 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10428 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10429 declared to have a type such as:
10430
10431 @smallexample
10432 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10433 Id : Integer;
10434 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10435 end record;
10436 @end smallexample
10437
10438 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10439 assignments:
10440
10441 @smallexample
10442 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10443 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10444 @end smallexample
10445
10446 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10447 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10448 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10449 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10450 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10451 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10452 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10453 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10454
10455 @item
10456 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10457
10458 @item
10459 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10460 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
10461 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
10462 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
10463 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
10464
10465 @item
10466 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10467
10468 @item
10469 Entry calls are not implemented.
10470
10471 @item
10472 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10473 formats are not supported.
10474
10475 @item
10476 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10477 @end itemize
10478
10479 @node Additions to Ada
10480 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10481 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10482
10483 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10484 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10485
10486 @itemize @bullet
10487 @item
10488 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
10489 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
10490 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
10491 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
10492 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
10493 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
10494 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
10495 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10496
10497 @item
10498 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
10499 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
10500 surround it in single quotes.
10501
10502 @item
10503 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10504 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10505
10506 @item
10507 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10508 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10509 @end itemize
10510
10511 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
10512 to Ada:
10513
10514 @itemize @bullet
10515 @item
10516 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10517 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10518
10519 @smallexample
10520 set x := y + 3
10521 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10522 @end smallexample
10523
10524 @item
10525 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10526 the value of its right-hand operand.
10527 This allows, for example,
10528 complex conditional breaks:
10529
10530 @smallexample
10531 break f
10532 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10533 @end smallexample
10534
10535 @item
10536 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10537 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10538 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10539 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10540 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10541 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10542 in strings. For example,
10543 @smallexample
10544 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10545 @end smallexample
10546 @noindent
10547 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
10548 period.
10549
10550 @item
10551 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10552 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10553 to write
10554
10555 @smallexample
10556 print 'max(x, y)
10557 @end smallexample
10558
10559 @item
10560 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10561 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10562 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
10563
10564 @smallexample
10565 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10566 @end smallexample
10567
10568 @noindent
10569 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10570 clause.
10571
10572 @item
10573 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10574 multi-character subsequence of
10575 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10576 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10577 in place of @t{a'length}.
10578
10579 @item
10580 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10581 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10582 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10583 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10584 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10585 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10586 For example,
10587 @smallexample
10588 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10589 @end smallexample
10590
10591 @item
10592 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10593 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10594 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10595 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10596 object.
10597
10598 @end itemize
10599
10600 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10601 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10602
10603 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10604 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10605 before reaching the main procedure.
10606 As defined in the Ada Reference
10607 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10608 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10609 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10610 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10611
10612 @node Ada Glitches
10613 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10614 @cindex Ada, problems
10615
10616 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10617 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10618 @value{GDBN},
10619 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10620 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10621
10622 @itemize @bullet
10623 @item
10624 Currently, the debugger
10625 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10626 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10627 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10628 to get it printed properly.
10629
10630 @item
10631 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10632 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10633
10634 @item
10635 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10636 argument lists are treated as positional).
10637
10638 @item
10639 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10640
10641 @item
10642 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10643 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10644 the host machine.
10645
10646 @item
10647 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10648
10649 @item
10650 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10651 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10652 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10653 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10654 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10655 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10656 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10657 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10658 you can usually resolve the confusion
10659 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10660 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10661 @end itemize
10662
10663 @node Unsupported languages
10664 @section Unsupported languages
10665
10666 @cindex unsupported languages
10667 @cindex minimal language
10668 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10669 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10670 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10671 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10672 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10673 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10674
10675 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10676 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10677 language.
10678
10679 @node Symbols
10680 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10681
10682 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10683 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10684 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10685 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10686 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10687 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
10688 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10689
10690 @cindex symbol names
10691 @cindex names of symbols
10692 @cindex quoting names
10693 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10694 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10695 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10696 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
10697 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10698 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10699 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10700 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10701
10702 @smallexample
10703 p 'foo.c'::x
10704 @end smallexample
10705
10706 @noindent
10707 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10708
10709 @table @code
10710 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10711 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10712 @kindex set case-sensitive
10713 @item set case-sensitive on
10714 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10715 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10716 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10717 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10718 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10719 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10720 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10721 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10722 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10723 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10724 case-insensitive matches.
10725
10726 @kindex show case-sensitive
10727 @item show case-sensitive
10728 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10729 lookups.
10730
10731 @kindex info address
10732 @cindex address of a symbol
10733 @item info address @var{symbol}
10734 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10735 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10736 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10737 is always stored.
10738
10739 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10740 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10741 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10742
10743 @kindex info symbol
10744 @cindex symbol from address
10745 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10746 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10747 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10748 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10749 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10750
10751 @smallexample
10752 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10753 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10754 @end smallexample
10755
10756 @noindent
10757 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10758 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10759
10760 @kindex whatis
10761 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10762 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10763 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10764 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10765 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10766 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10767 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10768 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10769 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10770 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10771 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10772
10773 @kindex ptype
10774 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10775 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10776 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10777 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10778
10779 For example, for this variable declaration:
10780
10781 @smallexample
10782 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10783 @end smallexample
10784
10785 @noindent
10786 the two commands give this output:
10787
10788 @smallexample
10789 @group
10790 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10791 type = struct complex
10792 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10793 type = struct complex @{
10794 double real;
10795 double imag;
10796 @}
10797 @end group
10798 @end smallexample
10799
10800 @noindent
10801 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10802 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10803
10804 @cindex incomplete type
10805 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10806 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10807 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10808 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10809 given these declarations:
10810
10811 @smallexample
10812 struct foo;
10813 struct foo *fooptr;
10814 @end smallexample
10815
10816 @noindent
10817 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10818
10819 @smallexample
10820 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10821 $1 = <incomplete type>
10822 @end smallexample
10823
10824 @noindent
10825 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10826 completely specified.
10827
10828 @kindex info types
10829 @item info types @var{regexp}
10830 @itemx info types
10831 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10832 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10833 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10834 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10835 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10836 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10837 name is @code{value}.
10838
10839 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10840 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10841 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10842
10843 @kindex info scope
10844 @cindex local variables
10845 @item info scope @var{location}
10846 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10847 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10848 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10849 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10850
10851 @smallexample
10852 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10853 Scope for command_line_handler:
10854 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10855 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10856 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10857 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10858 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10859 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10860 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10861 @end smallexample
10862
10863 @noindent
10864 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10865 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10866 collect}.
10867
10868 @kindex info source
10869 @item info source
10870 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10871 the function containing the current point of execution:
10872 @itemize @bullet
10873 @item
10874 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10875 @item
10876 the directory it was compiled in,
10877 @item
10878 its length, in lines,
10879 @item
10880 which programming language it is written in,
10881 @item
10882 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10883 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10884 @item
10885 whether the debugging information includes information about
10886 preprocessor macros.
10887 @end itemize
10888
10889
10890 @kindex info sources
10891 @item info sources
10892 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10893 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10894 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10895
10896 @kindex info functions
10897 @item info functions
10898 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10899
10900 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10901 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10902 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10903 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10904 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10905 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10906 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10907 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10908
10909 @kindex info variables
10910 @item info variables
10911 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10912 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10913
10914 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10915 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10916 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10917 @var{regexp}.
10918
10919 @kindex info classes
10920 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10921 @item info classes
10922 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10923 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10924 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10925 expression.
10926
10927 @kindex info selectors
10928 @item info selectors
10929 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10930 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10931 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10932 expression.
10933
10934 @ignore
10935 This was never implemented.
10936 @kindex info methods
10937 @item info methods
10938 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10939 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10940 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10941 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10942 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10943 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10944 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10945 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10946 @end ignore
10947
10948 @cindex reloading symbols
10949 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10950 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10951 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10952 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10953 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10954
10955 @table @code
10956 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10957 @item set symbol-reloading on
10958 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10959 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10960
10961 @item set symbol-reloading off
10962 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10963 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10964 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10965 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10966 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10967 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10968 name.
10969
10970 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10971 @item show symbol-reloading
10972 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10973 @end table
10974
10975 @cindex opaque data types
10976 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10977 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10978 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10979 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10980 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10981 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10982 another source file. The default is on.
10983
10984 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10985 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10986
10987 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10988 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10989 is printed as follows:
10990 @smallexample
10991 @{<no data fields>@}
10992 @end smallexample
10993
10994 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10995 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10996 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10997
10998 @kindex maint print symbols
10999 @cindex symbol dump
11000 @kindex maint print psymbols
11001 @cindex partial symbol dump
11002 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11003 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11004 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11005 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11006 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11007 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11008 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11009 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11010 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11011 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11012 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11013 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11014 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11015 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11016 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11017 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
11018 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11019
11020 @kindex maint info symtabs
11021 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11022 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11023 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11024 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11025 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11026 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11027 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11028
11029 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11030 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11031 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11032 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11033 structure in more detail. For example:
11034
11035 @smallexample
11036 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11037 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11038 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11039 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11040 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11041 readin no
11042 fullname (null)
11043 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11044 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11045 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11046 dependencies (none)
11047 @}
11048 @}
11049 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11050 (@value{GDBP})
11051 @end smallexample
11052 @noindent
11053 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11054 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11055 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11056 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11057 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11058
11059 @smallexample
11060 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11061 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11062 line 1574.
11063 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11064 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11065 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11066 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11067 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11068 dirname (null)
11069 fullname (null)
11070 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11071 debugformat DWARF 2
11072 @}
11073 @}
11074 (@value{GDBP})
11075 @end smallexample
11076 @end table
11077
11078
11079 @node Altering
11080 @chapter Altering Execution
11081
11082 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11083 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11084 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11085 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11086 program.
11087
11088 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11089 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11090 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11091
11092 @menu
11093 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11094 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11095 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11096 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11097 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11098 * Patching:: Patching your program
11099 @end menu
11100
11101 @node Assignment
11102 @section Assignment to variables
11103
11104 @cindex assignment
11105 @cindex setting variables
11106 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11107 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11108
11109 @smallexample
11110 print x=4
11111 @end smallexample
11112
11113 @noindent
11114 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11115 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11116 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11117 information on operators in supported languages.
11118
11119 @kindex set variable
11120 @cindex variables, setting
11121 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11122 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11123 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11124 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11125 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11126
11127 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11128 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11129 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11130 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11131 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11132 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11133 command @code{set width}:
11134
11135 @smallexample
11136 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11137 type = double
11138 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11139 $4 = 13
11140 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11141 Invalid syntax in expression.
11142 @end smallexample
11143
11144 @noindent
11145 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11146 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11147
11148 @smallexample
11149 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11150 @end smallexample
11151
11152 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11153 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11154 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11155 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11156 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11157 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11158
11159 @smallexample
11160 @group
11161 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11162 type = double
11163 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11164 $1 = 1
11165 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11166 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11167 $2 = 1
11168 (@value{GDBP}) r
11169 The program being debugged has been started already.
11170 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11171 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11172 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11173 Invalid bfd target.
11174 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11175 The current BFD target is "=4".
11176 @end group
11177 @end smallexample
11178
11179 @noindent
11180 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11181 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11182 @code{g}, use
11183
11184 @smallexample
11185 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11186 @end smallexample
11187
11188 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11189 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11190 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11191 same length or shorter.
11192 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11193 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11194
11195 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11196 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11197 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11198 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11199 and representation in memory), and
11200
11201 @smallexample
11202 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11203 @end smallexample
11204
11205 @noindent
11206 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11207
11208 @node Jumping
11209 @section Continuing at a different address
11210
11211 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11212 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11213 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11214
11215 @table @code
11216 @kindex jump
11217 @item jump @var{linespec}
11218 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11219 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11220 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11221 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11222 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11223 breakpoints}.
11224
11225 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11226 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11227 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11228 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11229 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11230 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11231 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11232 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11233 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11234
11235 @item jump *@var{address}
11236 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11237 @end table
11238
11239 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11240 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11241 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11242 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11243 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11244 example,
11245
11246 @smallexample
11247 set $pc = 0x485
11248 @end smallexample
11249
11250 @noindent
11251 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11252 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11253 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
11254
11255 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11256 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11257 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11258 detail.
11259
11260 @c @group
11261 @node Signaling
11262 @section Giving your program a signal
11263 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11264
11265 @table @code
11266 @kindex signal
11267 @item signal @var{signal}
11268 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11269 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11270 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11271 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11272
11273 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11274 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11275 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11276 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11277 signal.
11278
11279 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11280 after executing the command.
11281 @end table
11282 @c @end group
11283
11284 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11285 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11286 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11287 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11288 passes the signal directly to your program.
11289
11290
11291 @node Returning
11292 @section Returning from a function
11293
11294 @table @code
11295 @cindex returning from a function
11296 @kindex return
11297 @item return
11298 @itemx return @var{expression}
11299 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11300 command. If you give an
11301 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11302 value.
11303 @end table
11304
11305 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11306 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11307 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11308 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11309
11310 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11311 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11312 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11313 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11314 of functions.
11315
11316 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11317 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11318 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11319 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
11320 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11321
11322 @node Calling
11323 @section Calling program functions
11324
11325 @table @code
11326 @cindex calling functions
11327 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11328 @item print @var{expr}
11329 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resuling value.
11330 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11331 debugged.
11332
11333 @kindex call
11334 @item call @var{expr}
11335 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11336 returned values.
11337
11338 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11339 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11340 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11341 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11342 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11343 value history.
11344 @end table
11345
11346 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11347 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11348 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11349 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11350
11351 @table @code
11352 @item set unwindonsignal
11353 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11354 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11355 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11356 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11357 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11358 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11359 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11360 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11361 received.
11362
11363 @item show unwindonsignal
11364 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11365 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11366 @value{GDBN}.
11367 @end table
11368
11369 @cindex weak alias functions
11370 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11371 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11372 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11373 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11374 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11375 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11376 function instead.
11377
11378 @node Patching
11379 @section Patching programs
11380
11381 @cindex patching binaries
11382 @cindex writing into executables
11383 @cindex writing into corefiles
11384
11385 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11386 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11387 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11388 patching your program's binary.
11389
11390 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11391 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11392 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11393 repairs.
11394
11395 @table @code
11396 @kindex set write
11397 @item set write on
11398 @itemx set write off
11399 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11400 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11401 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11402
11403 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11404 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11405 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11406
11407 @item show write
11408 @kindex show write
11409 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11410 as well as reading.
11411 @end table
11412
11413 @node GDB Files
11414 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11415
11416 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11417 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11418 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11419 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11420
11421 @menu
11422 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11423 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11424 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11425 @end menu
11426
11427 @node Files
11428 @section Commands to specify files
11429
11430 @cindex symbol table
11431 @cindex core dump file
11432
11433 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11434 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11435 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11436 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11437
11438 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11439 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11440 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11441 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file}). In these situations the
11442 @value{GDBN} commands to specify new files are useful.
11443
11444 @table @code
11445 @cindex executable file
11446 @kindex file
11447 @item file @var{filename}
11448 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11449 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11450 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11451 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11452 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11453 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11454 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11455 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11456
11457 @cindex unlinked object files
11458 @cindex patching object files
11459 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11460 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11461 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11462 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11463 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11464 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11465 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11466 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11467
11468 @item file
11469 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11470 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11471
11472 @kindex exec-file
11473 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11474 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11475 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11476 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11477 discard information on the executable file.
11478
11479 @kindex symbol-file
11480 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11481 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11482 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11483 table and program to run from the same file.
11484
11485 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11486 program's symbol table.
11487
11488 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11489 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11490 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11491 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11492 @value{GDBN}.
11493
11494 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11495 executing it once.
11496
11497 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11498 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11499 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11500 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11501 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11502 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11503 optimized code.
11504
11505 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11506 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11507 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11508 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11509 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11510
11511 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11512 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11513 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11514 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11515 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11516 warnings and messages}.)
11517
11518 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11519 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11520 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11521 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11522 in stabs format.
11523
11524 @kindex readnow
11525 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11526 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11527 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11528 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11529 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11530 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11531 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11532 entire symbol table available.
11533
11534 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11535 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11536 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11537 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11538 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11539 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11540 @c files.
11541
11542 @kindex core-file
11543 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11544 @itemx core
11545 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11546 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11547 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11548 executable file itself for other parts.
11549
11550 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11551 to be used.
11552
11553 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11554 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11555 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11556 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11557 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
11558
11559 @kindex add-symbol-file
11560 @cindex dynamic linking
11561 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11562 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11563 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11564 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11565 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11566 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11567 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11568 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11569 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11570 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11571 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11572 @var{address} as an expression.
11573
11574 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11575 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11576 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11577 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11578 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11579
11580 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11581 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11582 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11583 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11584 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11585 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11586 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11587 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11588 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11589
11590 @itemize @bullet
11591 @item
11592 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11593 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11594 @item
11595 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11596 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11597 @item
11598 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11599 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11600 @end itemize
11601
11602 @noindent
11603 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11604 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11605 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11606 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11607 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11608 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11609 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11610 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11611 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11612 way.
11613
11614 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11615
11616 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11617 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11618 @cindex load symbols from memory
11619 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11620 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11621 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11622 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11623 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11624 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11625 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11626 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11627 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11628
11629 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11630 @kindex assf
11631 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11632 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11633 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11634 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11635 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11636 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11637 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11638 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11639 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11640 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11641
11642 @kindex section
11643 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11644 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11645 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11646 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11647 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11648 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11649 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11650 their addresses.
11651
11652 @kindex info files
11653 @kindex info target
11654 @item info files
11655 @itemx info target
11656 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11657 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11658 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11659 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11660 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11661 current ones.
11662
11663 @kindex maint info sections
11664 @item maint info sections
11665 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11666 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11667 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11668 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11669 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11670 may be arbitrarily combined):
11671
11672 @table @code
11673 @item ALLOBJ
11674 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11675 @item @var{sections}
11676 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11677 @item @var{section-flags}
11678 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11679 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11680 @table @code
11681 @item ALLOC
11682 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11683 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11684 @item LOAD
11685 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11686 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11687 @item RELOC
11688 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11689 @item READONLY
11690 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11691 @item CODE
11692 Section contains executable code only.
11693 @item DATA
11694 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11695 @item ROM
11696 Section will reside in ROM.
11697 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11698 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11699 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11700 Section is not empty.
11701 @item NEVER_LOAD
11702 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11703 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11704 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11705 COFF shared library information.
11706 @item IS_COMMON
11707 Section contains common symbols.
11708 @end table
11709 @end table
11710 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11711 @cindex read-only sections
11712 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11713 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11714 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11715 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11716 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11717 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11718 enhancement to debugging performance.
11719
11720 The default is off.
11721
11722 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11723 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11724 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11725 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11726
11727 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11728 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11729 @end table
11730
11731 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11732 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11733 name and remembers it that way.
11734
11735 @cindex shared libraries
11736 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11737 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11738
11739 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11740 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11741 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11742 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11743 debugging a core file).
11744
11745 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11746 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11747
11748 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11749 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11750 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11751
11752 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11753 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11754 particularly large or there are many of them.
11755
11756 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11757 commands:
11758
11759 @table @code
11760 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11761 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11762 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11763 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11764 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11765 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11766 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11767 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11768
11769 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11770 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11771 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11772 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11773 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11774 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11775 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11776 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expresion that matches
11777 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11778
11779 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11780 @item show auto-solib-add
11781 Display the current autoloading mode.
11782 @end table
11783
11784 @cindex load shared library
11785 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11786 command:
11787
11788 @table @code
11789 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11790 @kindex info share
11791 @item info share
11792 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11793 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11794
11795 @kindex sharedlibrary
11796 @kindex share
11797 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11798 @itemx share @var{regex}
11799 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11800 Unix regular expression.
11801 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11802 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11803 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11804 loaded.
11805
11806 @item nosharedlibrary
11807 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11808 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11809 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11810 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11811 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11812 discarded.
11813 @end table
11814
11815 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11816 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11817 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11818
11819 @table @code
11820 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11821 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11822 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11823 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11824 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11825 shared library.
11826
11827 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11828 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11829 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11830 library events happen.
11831 @end table
11832
11833 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11834 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11835 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11836 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11837 not.
11838
11839 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11840 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11841 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11842 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11843 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11844
11845 @table @code
11846 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11847 @cindex system root, alternate
11848 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11849 @kindex set sysroot
11850 @item set sysroot @var{path}
11851 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
11852 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
11853 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
11854 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
11855 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
11856 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
11857 under @var{path}.
11858
11859 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
11860 sysroot}.
11861
11862 @cindex default system root
11863 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11864 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
11865 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
11866 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
11867 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
11868 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
11869 location.
11870
11871 @kindex show sysroot
11872 @item show sysroot
11873 Display the current shared library prefix.
11874
11875 @kindex set solib-search-path
11876 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11877 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
11878 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
11879 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
11880 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
11881 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
11882 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistant directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
11883 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
11884 it to a nonexistant directory may interfere with automatic loading
11885 of shared library symbols.
11886
11887 @kindex show solib-search-path
11888 @item show solib-search-path
11889 Display the current shared library search path.
11890 @end table
11891
11892
11893 @node Separate Debug Files
11894 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11895 @cindex separate debugging information files
11896 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11897 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11898 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11899 @cindex global debugging information directory
11900
11901 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11902 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11903 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11904 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11905 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11906 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11907 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11908
11909 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11910 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11911 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11912 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11913 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11914 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11915 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11916 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11917 places:
11918
11919 @itemize @bullet
11920 @item
11921 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11922 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11923 @item
11924 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11925 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11926 @item
11927 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11928 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11929 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11930 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11931 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11932 @end itemize
11933 @noindent
11934 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11935 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11936 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11937
11938 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11939 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11940 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11941 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11942 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11943 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11944
11945 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11946 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11947
11948 @table @code
11949
11950 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11951 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11952 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11953 information files to @var{directory}.
11954
11955 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11956 @item show debug-file-directory
11957 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11958 information files.
11959
11960 @end table
11961
11962 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11963 @cindex debug links
11964 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11965 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11966
11967 @itemize
11968 @item
11969 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11970 a zero byte,
11971 @item
11972 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11973 boundary within the section, and
11974 @item
11975 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11976 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11977 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11978 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11979 @end itemize
11980
11981 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11982 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11983 described above.
11984
11985 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11986 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11987 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11988 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11989 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11990 in an ordinary executable.
11991
11992 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11993 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11994 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11995 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11996 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11997 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11998 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11999
12000 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
12001 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
12002 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
12003 complete code for a function that computes it:
12004
12005 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12006 @smallexample
12007 unsigned long
12008 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12009 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12010 @{
12011 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12012 @{
12013 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12014 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12015 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12016 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12017 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12018 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12019 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12020 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12021 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12022 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12023 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12024 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12025 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12026 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12027 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12028 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12029 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12030 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12031 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12032 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12033 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12034 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12035 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12036 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12037 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12038 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12039 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12040 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12041 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12042 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12043 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12044 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12045 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12046 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12047 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12048 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12049 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12050 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12051 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12052 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12053 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12054 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12055 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12056 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12057 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12058 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12059 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12060 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12061 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12062 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12063 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12064 0x2d02ef8d
12065 @};
12066 unsigned char *end;
12067
12068 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12069 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12070 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12071 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12072 @}
12073 @end smallexample
12074
12075
12076 @node Symbol Errors
12077 @section Errors reading symbol files
12078
12079 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12080 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12081 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12082 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12083 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12084 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12085 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12086 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12087 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12088 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12089 messages}).
12090
12091 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12092
12093 @table @code
12094 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12095
12096 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12097 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12098 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12099 in its outer scope blocks.
12100
12101 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12102 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12103 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12104 function.
12105
12106 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12107
12108 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12109 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12110 do so.
12111
12112 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12113 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12114 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12115 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12116 messages}.)
12117
12118 @item bad block start address patched
12119
12120 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12121 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12122 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12123
12124 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12125 starting on the previous source line.
12126
12127 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12128
12129 @cindex foo
12130 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12131 larger than the size of the string table.
12132
12133 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12134 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12135 with this name.
12136
12137 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12138
12139 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12140 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12141 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12142
12143 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12144 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12145 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12146 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12147 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12148 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12149
12150 @item stub type has NULL name
12151
12152 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12153
12154 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12155 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12156 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12157 it.
12158
12159 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12160
12161 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12162
12163 @end table
12164
12165 @node Targets
12166 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12167
12168 @cindex debugging target
12169 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12170
12171 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12172 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12173 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12174 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12175 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12176 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12177 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12178 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
12179
12180 @cindex target architecture
12181 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12182 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12183 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12184 command.
12185
12186 @table @code
12187 @kindex set architecture
12188 @kindex show architecture
12189 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12190 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12191 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12192 supported architectures.
12193
12194 @item show architecture
12195 Show the current target architecture.
12196
12197 @item set processor
12198 @itemx processor
12199 @kindex set processor
12200 @kindex show processor
12201 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12202 and @code{show architecture}.
12203 @end table
12204
12205 @menu
12206 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12207 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12208 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12209 * Remote:: Remote debugging
12210
12211 @end menu
12212
12213 @node Active Targets
12214 @section Active targets
12215
12216 @cindex stacking targets
12217 @cindex active targets
12218 @cindex multiple targets
12219
12220 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12221 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12222 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12223 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12224 a core file.
12225
12226 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12227 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12228 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12229 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12230 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12231 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12232 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12233 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12234 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12235
12236 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12237 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12238 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12239 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12240 process target is active.
12241
12242 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12243 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
12244 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12245 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
12246 process}).
12247
12248 @node Target Commands
12249 @section Commands for managing targets
12250
12251 @table @code
12252 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12253 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12254 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12255 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12256 protocol of the target machine.
12257
12258 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12259 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12260 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12261
12262 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12263 after executing the command.
12264
12265 @kindex help target
12266 @item help target
12267 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12268 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12269 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
12270
12271 @item help target @var{name}
12272 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12273 select it.
12274
12275 @kindex set gnutarget
12276 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12277 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12278 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12279 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12280 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12281 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12282
12283 @quotation
12284 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12285 you must know the actual BFD name.
12286 @end quotation
12287
12288 @noindent
12289 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
12290
12291 @kindex show gnutarget
12292 @item show gnutarget
12293 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12294 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12295 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12296 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12297 @end table
12298
12299 @cindex common targets
12300 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12301 configuration):
12302
12303 @table @code
12304 @kindex target
12305 @item target exec @var{program}
12306 @cindex executable file target
12307 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12308 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12309
12310 @item target core @var{filename}
12311 @cindex core dump file target
12312 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12313 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12314
12315 @item target remote @var{medium}
12316 @cindex remote target
12317 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12318 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12319 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12320
12321 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12322 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12323
12324 @smallexample
12325 target remote /dev/ttya
12326 @end smallexample
12327
12328 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12329 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12330 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12331 clobbered by the download.
12332
12333 @item target sim
12334 @cindex built-in simulator target
12335 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12336 In general,
12337 @smallexample
12338 target sim
12339 load
12340 run
12341 @end smallexample
12342 @noindent
12343 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12344 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12345 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12346 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12347 Processors}.
12348
12349 @end table
12350
12351 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12352
12353 @table @code
12354
12355 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12356 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12357 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12358
12359 @end table
12360
12361 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12362 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12363
12364 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12365 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12366 various aspects of this process.
12367
12368 @table @code
12369
12370 @item set hash
12371 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12372 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12373 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12374 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12375 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12376 monitor.
12377
12378 @item show hash
12379 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12380 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12381
12382 @item set debug monitor
12383 @kindex set debug monitor
12384 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12385 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12386 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12387
12388 @item show debug monitor
12389 @kindex show debug monitor
12390 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12391 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12392 @end table
12393
12394 @table @code
12395
12396 @kindex load @var{filename}
12397 @item load @var{filename}
12398 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12399 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12400 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12401 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12402 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12403 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12404
12405 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12406 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12407 target is @dots{}}''
12408
12409 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12410 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12411 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12412 specifies a fixed address.
12413 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12414
12415 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12416 load programs into flash memory.
12417
12418 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12419 @end table
12420
12421 @node Byte Order
12422 @section Choosing target byte order
12423
12424 @cindex choosing target byte order
12425 @cindex target byte order
12426
12427 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12428 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12429 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12430 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12431 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12432 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12433
12434 @table @code
12435 @kindex set endian
12436 @item set endian big
12437 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12438
12439 @item set endian little
12440 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12441
12442 @item set endian auto
12443 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12444 executable.
12445
12446 @item show endian
12447 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12448
12449 @end table
12450
12451 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12452 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12453 target system.
12454
12455 @node Remote
12456 @section Remote debugging
12457 @cindex remote debugging
12458
12459 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12460 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12461 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12462 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12463 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12464
12465 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12466 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12467 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12468 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12469 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12470 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12471
12472 Other remote targets may be available in your
12473 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12474
12475 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
12476 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
12477
12478 @table @code
12479 @item remote @var{command}
12480 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
12481 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12482 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
12483 @end table
12484
12485
12486 @node Remote Debugging
12487 @chapter Debugging remote programs
12488
12489 @menu
12490 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12491 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12492 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
12493 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12494 @end menu
12495
12496 @node Connecting
12497 @section Connecting to a remote target
12498
12499 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12500 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
12501 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12502 program as the first argument.
12503
12504 @cindex @code{target remote}
12505 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12506 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12507 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12508 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12509 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12510 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12511
12512 @table @code
12513
12514 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12515 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12516 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12517 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12518
12519 @smallexample
12520 target remote /dev/ttyb
12521 @end smallexample
12522
12523 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12524 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12525 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12526 @code{target} command.
12527
12528 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12529 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12530 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12531 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12532 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12533 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12534 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12535 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12536 target.
12537
12538 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12539 @code{manyfarms}:
12540
12541 @smallexample
12542 target remote manyfarms:2828
12543 @end smallexample
12544
12545 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12546 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12547 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12548 port 1234 on your local machine:
12549
12550 @smallexample
12551 target remote :1234
12552 @end smallexample
12553 @noindent
12554
12555 Note that the colon is still required here.
12556
12557 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12558 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12559 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12560 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12561
12562 @smallexample
12563 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12564 @end smallexample
12565
12566 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12567 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12568 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12569 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12570
12571 @item target remote | @var{command}
12572 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12573 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12574 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12575 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12576 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12577 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12578 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12579 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12580
12581 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12582 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12583 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12584
12585 @end table
12586
12587 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12588 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12589 remote program.
12590
12591 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12592 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12593 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12594 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12595 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12596 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12597 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12598
12599 @smallexample
12600 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12601 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12602 @end smallexample
12603
12604 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12605 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12606 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12607 goes back to waiting.
12608
12609 @table @code
12610 @kindex detach (remote)
12611 @item detach
12612 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12613 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12614 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12615 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12616 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12617
12618 @kindex disconnect
12619 @item disconnect
12620 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12621 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12622 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12623 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12624 another target.
12625
12626 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12627 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12628 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12629 @kindex monitor
12630 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12631 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12632 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12633 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12634 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12635 and implement.
12636 @end table
12637
12638 @node Server
12639 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
12640
12641 @kindex gdbserver
12642 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12643 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12644 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12645 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12646
12647 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12648 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12649 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12650 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12651 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12652 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12653 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12654 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12655 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12656 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12657 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12658 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12659 choice for debugging.
12660
12661 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12662 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12663 protocol.
12664
12665 @table @emph
12666 @item On the target machine,
12667 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12668 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12669 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12670 system does all the symbol handling.
12671
12672 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12673 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12674 syntax is:
12675
12676 @smallexample
12677 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12678 @end smallexample
12679
12680 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12681 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12682 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12683 @file{/dev/com1}:
12684
12685 @smallexample
12686 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12687 @end smallexample
12688
12689 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12690 with it.
12691
12692 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12693
12694 @smallexample
12695 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12696 @end smallexample
12697
12698 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12699 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12700 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12701 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12702 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12703 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12704 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12705 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12706 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12707 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12708 @code{target remote} command.
12709
12710 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12711 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12712
12713 @smallexample
12714 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12715 @end smallexample
12716
12717 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12718 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12719
12720 @pindex pidof
12721 @cindex attach to a program by name
12722 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12723 @code{pidof} utility:
12724
12725 @smallexample
12726 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
12727 @end smallexample
12728
12729 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
12730 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12731 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12732
12733 @item On the host machine,
12734 first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
12735 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
12736 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
12737 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
12738
12739 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
12740 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
12741 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
12742 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
12743 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
12744 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
12745 programs.
12746
12747 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12748 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12749 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12750 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12751 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12752 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12753 already on the target.
12754
12755 @end table
12756
12757 @node Remote configuration
12758 @section Remote configuration
12759
12760 @kindex set remote
12761 @kindex show remote
12762 This section documents the configuration options available when
12763 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12764 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12765 system-call-allowed}.
12766
12767 @table @code
12768 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12769 @cindex adress size for remote targets
12770 @cindex bits in remote address
12771 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12772 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12773 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12774 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12775
12776 @item show remoteaddresssize
12777 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12778
12779 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12780 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12781 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12782 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12783 remote targets.
12784
12785 @item show remotebaud
12786 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12787
12788 @item set remotebreak
12789 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12790 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12791 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12792 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12793 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12794 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12795 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12796 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12797
12798 @item show remotebreak
12799 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12800 interrupt the remote program.
12801
12802 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12803 @cindex serial port name
12804 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12805 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12806 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12807 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12808 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12809 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12810 arguments.)
12811
12812 @item show remotedevice
12813 Show the current name of the serial port.
12814
12815 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12816 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12817 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12818 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12819 @code{ascii}.
12820
12821 @item show remotelogbase
12822 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12823 protocol.
12824
12825 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12826 @cindex record serial communications on file
12827 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12828 default is not to record at all.
12829
12830 @item show remotelogfile.
12831 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12832 serial communications.
12833
12834 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12835 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12836 @cindex remote timeout
12837 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12838 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12839
12840 @item show remotetimeout
12841 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12842 responses.
12843
12844 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12845 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12846 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12847 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12848 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12849 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12850 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12851 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12852 @end table
12853
12854 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
12855 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
12856 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
12857 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
12858 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
12859 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
12860 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
12861 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
12862 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
12863
12864 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
12865 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
12866 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
12867 @value{GDBN} developers.
12868
12869 The available settings are:
12870
12871 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.2 0.35
12872 @item Command Name
12873 @tab Remote Packet
12874 @tab Related Features
12875
12876 @item @code{fetch-register-packet}
12877 @tab @code{p}
12878 @tab @code{info registers}
12879
12880 @item @code{set-register-packet}
12881 @tab @code{P}
12882 @tab @code{set}
12883
12884 @item @code{binary-download-packet}
12885 @tab @code{X}
12886 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
12887
12888 @item @code{read-aux-vector-packet}
12889 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
12890 @tab @code{info auxv}
12891
12892 @item @code{symbol-lookup-packet}
12893 @tab @code{qSymbol}
12894 @tab Detecting multiple threads
12895
12896 @item @code{verbose-resume-packet}
12897 @tab @code{vCont}
12898 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
12899
12900 @item @code{software-breakpoint-packet}
12901 @tab @code{Z0}
12902 @tab @code{break}
12903
12904 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint-packet}
12905 @tab @code{Z1}
12906 @tab @code{hbreak}
12907
12908 @item @code{write-watchpoint-packet}
12909 @tab @code{Z2}
12910 @tab @code{watch}
12911
12912 @item @code{read-watchpoint-packet}
12913 @tab @code{Z3}
12914 @tab @code{rwatch}
12915
12916 @item @code{access-watchpoint-packet}
12917 @tab @code{Z4}
12918 @tab @code{awatch}
12919
12920 @item @code{get-thread-local-storage-address-packet}
12921 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
12922 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
12923
12924 @item @code{supported-packets}
12925 @tab @code{qSupported}
12926 @tab Remote communications parameters
12927
12928 @item @code{pass-signals-packet}
12929 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
12930 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
12931
12932 @end multitable
12933
12934 @node remote stub
12935 @section Implementing a remote stub
12936
12937 @cindex debugging stub, example
12938 @cindex remote stub, example
12939 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12940 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12941 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12942 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12943 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12944 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12945 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12946 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12947
12948 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12949 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12950 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12951 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12952 program, you need:
12953
12954 @enumerate
12955 @item
12956 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12957 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12958 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12959
12960 @item
12961 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12962 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12963
12964 @item
12965 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12966 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12967 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12968 documentation.
12969 @end enumerate
12970
12971 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12972 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12973 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12974
12975 @table @emph
12976 @item On the host,
12977 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12978 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12979 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12980
12981 @item On the target,
12982 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12983 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12984 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12985
12986 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12987 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12988 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
12989 @end table
12990
12991 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12992 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12993 @sc{sparc} boards.
12994
12995 @cindex remote serial stub list
12996 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12997
12998 @table @code
12999
13000 @item i386-stub.c
13001 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13002 @cindex Intel
13003 @cindex i386
13004 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13005
13006 @item m68k-stub.c
13007 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13008 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13009 @cindex m680x0
13010 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13011
13012 @item sh-stub.c
13013 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13014 @cindex Renesas
13015 @cindex SH
13016 For Renesas SH architectures.
13017
13018 @item sparc-stub.c
13019 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13020 @cindex Sparc
13021 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13022
13023 @item sparcl-stub.c
13024 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13025 @cindex Fujitsu
13026 @cindex SparcLite
13027 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13028
13029 @end table
13030
13031 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13032 recently added stubs.
13033
13034 @menu
13035 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13036 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13037 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13038 @end menu
13039
13040 @node Stub Contents
13041 @subsection What the stub can do for you
13042
13043 @cindex remote serial stub
13044 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13045 subroutines:
13046
13047 @table @code
13048 @item set_debug_traps
13049 @findex set_debug_traps
13050 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13051 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13052 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13053 beginning of your program.
13054
13055 @item handle_exception
13056 @findex handle_exception
13057 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13058 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13059 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13060 run when a trap is triggered.
13061
13062 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13063 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13064 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13065 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13066 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13067 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13068 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13069 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13070 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13071 machine.
13072
13073 @item breakpoint
13074 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13075 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13076 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13077 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13078 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13079 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13080 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13081 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13082 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13083 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13084 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13085
13086 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13087 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13088 start of your debugging session.
13089 @end table
13090
13091 @node Bootstrapping
13092 @subsection What you must do for the stub
13093
13094 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13095 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13096 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13097 debugging target machine.
13098
13099 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13100 serial port.
13101
13102 @table @code
13103 @item int getDebugChar()
13104 @findex getDebugChar
13105 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13106 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13107 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13108
13109 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13110 @findex putDebugChar
13111 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13112 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13113 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13114 @end table
13115
13116 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13117 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13118 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13119 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13120 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13121 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13122 remote system to stop.
13123
13124 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13125 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13126 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13127 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13128
13129 Other routines you need to supply are:
13130
13131 @table @code
13132 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13133 @findex exceptionHandler
13134 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13135 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13136 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13137 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13138 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13139 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13140 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13141 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13142 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13143 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13144 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13145 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13146 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13147
13148 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13149 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13150 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13151 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13152 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13153
13154 @item void flush_i_cache()
13155 @findex flush_i_cache
13156 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13157 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13158 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13159
13160 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13161 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13162 @end table
13163
13164 @noindent
13165 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13166
13167 @table @code
13168 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13169 @findex memset
13170 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13171 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13172 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13173 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13174 @end table
13175
13176 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13177 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13178 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13179 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
13180
13181
13182 @node Debug Session
13183 @subsection Putting it all together
13184
13185 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13186 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13187 steps.
13188
13189 @enumerate
13190 @item
13191 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13192 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
13193 @display
13194 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13195 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13196 @end display
13197
13198 @item
13199 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13200
13201 @smallexample
13202 set_debug_traps();
13203 breakpoint();
13204 @end smallexample
13205
13206 @item
13207 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13208 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13209
13210 @smallexample
13211 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13212 @end smallexample
13213
13214 @noindent
13215 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13216 function in your program, that function is called when
13217 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13218 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13219 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13220
13221 @item
13222 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13223 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13224
13225 @item
13226 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13227 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13228
13229 @item
13230 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13231 @c document that. FIXME.
13232 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13233 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13234
13235 @item
13236 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13237 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
13238
13239 @end enumerate
13240
13241 @node Configurations
13242 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13243
13244 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13245 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13246 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13247
13248 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13249 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13250 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13251 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13252 are quite different from each other.
13253
13254 @menu
13255 * Native::
13256 * Embedded OS::
13257 * Embedded Processors::
13258 * Architectures::
13259 @end menu
13260
13261 @node Native
13262 @section Native
13263
13264 This section describes details specific to particular native
13265 configurations.
13266
13267 @menu
13268 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13269 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13270 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13271 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13272 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13273 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13274 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13275 @end menu
13276
13277 @node HP-UX
13278 @subsection HP-UX
13279
13280 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13281 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13282 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13283
13284
13285 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13286 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13287
13288 @cindex libkvm
13289 @cindex kernel memory image
13290 @cindex kernel crash dump
13291
13292 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13293 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13294 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13295 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13296 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13297 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13298 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13299 @code{kvm} target:
13300
13301 @smallexample
13302 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13303 @end smallexample
13304
13305 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13306 argument:
13307
13308 @smallexample
13309 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13310 @end smallexample
13311
13312 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13313 available:
13314
13315 @table @code
13316 @kindex kvm
13317 @item kvm pcb
13318 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13319
13320 @item kvm proc
13321 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13322 modern FreeBSD systems.
13323 @end table
13324
13325 @node SVR4 Process Information
13326 @subsection SVR4 process information
13327 @cindex /proc
13328 @cindex examine process image
13329 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13330
13331 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13332 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13333 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13334 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13335 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13336 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13337 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13338 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13339 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13340
13341 @table @code
13342 @kindex info proc
13343 @cindex process ID
13344 @item info proc
13345 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13346 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13347 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13348 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13349 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13350 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13351 executable file's absolute file name.
13352
13353 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13354 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13355 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13356 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13357 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13358 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13359
13360 @item info proc mappings
13361 @cindex memory address space mappings
13362 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13363 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13364 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13365 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13366 memory access rights to that range.
13367
13368 @item info proc stat
13369 @itemx info proc status
13370 @cindex process detailed status information
13371 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13372 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13373 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13374 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13375 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13376 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13377 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13378
13379 @item info proc all
13380 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13381 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13382
13383 @ignore
13384 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13385 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13386 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13387 @kindex info proc times
13388 @item info proc times
13389 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13390 its children.
13391
13392 @kindex info proc id
13393 @item info proc id
13394 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13395 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13396 @end ignore
13397
13398 @item set procfs-trace
13399 @kindex set procfs-trace
13400 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13401 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13402
13403 @item show procfs-trace
13404 @kindex show procfs-trace
13405 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13406
13407 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13408 @kindex set procfs-file
13409 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13410 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13411 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13412 standard output.
13413
13414 @item show procfs-file
13415 @kindex show procfs-file
13416 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13417
13418 @item proc-trace-entry
13419 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13420 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13421 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13422 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13423 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13424 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13425 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13426 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13427 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13428
13429 @item info pidlist
13430 @kindex info pidlist
13431 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13432 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13433 processes and all the threads within each process.
13434
13435 @item info meminfo
13436 @kindex info meminfo
13437 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13438 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13439 @end table
13440
13441 @node DJGPP Native
13442 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13443 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13444 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13445 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13446
13447 @cindex DPMI
13448 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13449 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13450 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13451 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13452
13453 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13454 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13455 subsection describes those commands.
13456
13457 @table @code
13458 @kindex info dos
13459 @item info dos
13460 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13461 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13462
13463 @kindex sysinfo
13464 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13465 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13466 @item info dos sysinfo
13467 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13468 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13469 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13470
13471 @cindex GDT
13472 @cindex LDT
13473 @cindex IDT
13474 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13475 @cindex descriptor tables display
13476 @item info dos gdt
13477 @itemx info dos ldt
13478 @itemx info dos idt
13479 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13480 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13481 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13482 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13483 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13484 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13485 rights.
13486
13487 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13488 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13489 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13490 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13491 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13492
13493 @cindex garbled pointers
13494 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13495 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13496 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13497 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13498 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13499 debugged program's data segment:
13500
13501 @smallexample
13502 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13503 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13504 @end smallexample
13505
13506 @noindent
13507 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13508 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13509
13510 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13511 @item info dos pde
13512 @itemx info dos pte
13513 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13514 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13515 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13516 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13517 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13518 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13519 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13520 that is currently in use.
13521
13522 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13523 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13524 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13525 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13526 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13527 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13528 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13529
13530 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13531 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13532 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13533 controller.
13534
13535 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13536
13537 @cindex physical address from linear address
13538 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13539 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13540 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13541 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13542 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13543 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13544 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13545
13546 @smallexample
13547 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13548 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13549 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13550 @end smallexample
13551
13552 @noindent
13553 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13554 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13555 attributes of that page.
13556
13557 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13558 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13559 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13560 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13561 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13562 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13563
13564 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13565 transfer buffer:
13566
13567 @smallexample
13568 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13569 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13570 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13571 @end smallexample
13572
13573 @noindent
13574 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13575 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13576 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13577 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13578 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13579
13580 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13581 @end table
13582
13583 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13584 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13585 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13586 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13587
13588 @table @code
13589 @kindex set com1base
13590 @kindex set com1irq
13591 @kindex set com2base
13592 @kindex set com2irq
13593 @kindex set com3base
13594 @kindex set com3irq
13595 @kindex set com4base
13596 @kindex set com4irq
13597 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13598 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13599 port.
13600
13601 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13602 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13603 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13604
13605 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13606 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13607 other 3 COM ports.
13608
13609 @kindex show com1base
13610 @kindex show com1irq
13611 @kindex show com2base
13612 @kindex show com2irq
13613 @kindex show com3base
13614 @kindex show com3irq
13615 @kindex show com4base
13616 @kindex show com4irq
13617 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13618 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13619 lines used by the COM ports.
13620
13621 @item info serial
13622 @kindex info serial
13623 @cindex DOS serial port status
13624 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13625 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13626 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13627 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13628 @end table
13629
13630
13631 @node Cygwin Native
13632 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
13633 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13634 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13635 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13636
13637 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13638 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13639 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
13640 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
13641 that have no debugging symbols.
13642
13643
13644 @table @code
13645 @kindex info w32
13646 @item info w32
13647 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13648 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13649
13650 @item info w32 selector
13651 This command displays information returned by
13652 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13653 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13654 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13655 Without argument, this command displays information
13656 about the the six segment registers.
13657
13658 @kindex info dll
13659 @item info dll
13660 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13661
13662 @kindex dll-symbols
13663 @item dll-symbols
13664 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13665 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13666
13667 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13668 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13669 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13670 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13671 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13672 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13673 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13674 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13675 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13676 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13677 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13678
13679 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13680 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13681 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13682 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13683
13684 @kindex set new-console
13685 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13686 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13687 be started in a new console on next start.
13688 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13689 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13690
13691 @kindex show new-console
13692 @item show new-console
13693 Displays whether a new console is used
13694 when the debuggee is started.
13695
13696 @kindex set new-group
13697 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13698 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13699 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13700 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13701 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13702
13703 @kindex show new-group
13704 @item show new-group
13705 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13706
13707 @kindex set debugevents
13708 @item set debugevents
13709 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13710 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13711 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13712 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13713 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13714
13715 @kindex set debugexec
13716 @item set debugexec
13717 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13718 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13719
13720 @kindex set debugexceptions
13721 @item set debugexceptions
13722 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13723 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13724
13725 @kindex set debugmemory
13726 @item set debugmemory
13727 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13728 and writes by the debugger.
13729
13730 @kindex set shell
13731 @item set shell
13732 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13733 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13734
13735 @kindex show shell
13736 @item show shell
13737 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13738
13739 @end table
13740
13741 @menu
13742 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13743 @end menu
13744
13745 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13746 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13747 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13748 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13749
13750 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13751 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13752 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13753 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13754 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13755 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13756 ``minimal symbols''.
13757
13758 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13759 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13760 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13761 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13762 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13763 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
13764 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13765 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13766 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13767 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13768
13769 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13770
13771 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13772 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13773 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13774 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13775 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13776 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13777 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13778 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13779 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13780
13781 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13782 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13783 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13784 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13785 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
13786 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13787
13788 @smallexample
13789 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13790 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13791
13792 Non-debugging symbols:
13793 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13794 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13795 @end smallexample
13796
13797 @smallexample
13798 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13799 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13800
13801 Non-debugging symbols:
13802 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13803 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13804 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13805 [etc...]
13806 @end smallexample
13807
13808 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13809
13810 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13811 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13812 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13813 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13814 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13815 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13816 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13817
13818 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13819 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13820 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13821 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13822 problem:
13823
13824 @smallexample
13825 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13826 $1 = 268572168
13827 @end smallexample
13828
13829 @smallexample
13830 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13831 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13832 @end smallexample
13833
13834 And two possible solutions:
13835
13836 @smallexample
13837 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13838 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13839 @end smallexample
13840
13841 @smallexample
13842 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13843 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13844 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13845 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13846 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13847 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13848 @end smallexample
13849
13850 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13851 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13852 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13853 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13854 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13855
13856 @smallexample
13857 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13858 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13859 @end smallexample
13860
13861 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13862 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13863 safe.
13864
13865 @node Hurd Native
13866 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13867 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13868
13869 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13870 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13871
13872 @table @code
13873 @item set signals
13874 @itemx set sigs
13875 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13876 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13877 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13878 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13879 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13880 @code{signals}.
13881
13882 @item show signals
13883 @itemx show sigs
13884 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13885 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13886 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13887
13888 @item set signal-thread
13889 @itemx set sigthread
13890 @kindex set signal-thread
13891 @kindex set sigthread
13892 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13893 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13894 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13895 signal-thread}.
13896
13897 @item show signal-thread
13898 @itemx show sigthread
13899 @kindex show signal-thread
13900 @kindex show sigthread
13901 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13902 delivered a signal.
13903
13904 @item set stopped
13905 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13906 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13907 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13908 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13909
13910 @item show stopped
13911 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13912 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13913 stopped.
13914
13915 @item set exceptions
13916 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13917 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13918 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13919 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13920 trapping on.
13921
13922 @item show exceptions
13923 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13924 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13925
13926 @item set task pause
13927 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13928 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13929 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13930 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13931 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13932 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13933 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13934 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13935 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13936
13937 @item show task pause
13938 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13939 Show the current state of task suspension.
13940
13941 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13942 @cindex task suspend count
13943 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13944 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13945 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13946
13947 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13948 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13949
13950 @item set task exception-port
13951 @itemx set task excp
13952 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13953 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13954 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13955 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13956
13957 @item set noninvasive
13958 @cindex noninvasive task options
13959 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13960 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13961 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13962 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13963
13964 @item info send-rights
13965 @itemx info receive-rights
13966 @itemx info port-rights
13967 @itemx info port-sets
13968 @itemx info dead-names
13969 @itemx info ports
13970 @itemx info psets
13971 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13972 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13973 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13974 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13975 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13976 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13977 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13978 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13979 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13980
13981 @item set thread pause
13982 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13983 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13984 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13985 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13986 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13987 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13988 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13989 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13990 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13991 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13992 only the current thread.
13993
13994 @item show thread pause
13995 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13996 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13997
13998 @item set thread run
13999 This comamnd sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14000
14001 @item show thread run
14002 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14003
14004 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14005 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14006 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14007 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14008 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14009 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14010 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14011
14012 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14013 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14014 detaching.
14015
14016 @item set thread exception-port
14017 @itemx set thread excp
14018 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14019 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14020 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14021
14022 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14023 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14024 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14025 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14026
14027 @item set thread default
14028 @itemx show thread default
14029 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14030 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14031 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14032 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14033 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14034 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14035 the non-default commands.
14036 @end table
14037
14038
14039 @node Neutrino
14040 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14041 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14042
14043 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14044 Neutrino target:
14045
14046 @table @code
14047 @item set debug nto-debug
14048 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14049 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14050 Neutrino support.
14051
14052 @item show debug nto-debug
14053 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14054 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14055 @end table
14056
14057
14058 @node Embedded OS
14059 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14060
14061 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14062 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14063 architectures.
14064
14065 @menu
14066 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14067 @end menu
14068
14069 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14070 various real-time operating systems.
14071
14072 @node VxWorks
14073 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14074
14075 @cindex VxWorks
14076
14077 @table @code
14078
14079 @kindex target vxworks
14080 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14081 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14082 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14083
14084 @end table
14085
14086 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14087 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14088
14089 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14090 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14091 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14092 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14093 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14094 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14095 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14096
14097 @table @code
14098 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14099 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14100 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14101 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14102 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14103 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14104 of a thin network line.
14105 @end table
14106
14107 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14108 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14109 procedures.
14110
14111 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14112 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14113 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14114 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14115 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14116 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14117 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14118 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14119 manual.
14120 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14121
14122 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14123 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14124 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14125 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14126
14127 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14128
14129 @smallexample
14130 (vxgdb)
14131 @end smallexample
14132
14133 @menu
14134 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14135 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14136 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14137 @end menu
14138
14139 @node VxWorks Connection
14140 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14141
14142 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14143 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14144
14145 @smallexample
14146 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14147 @end smallexample
14148
14149 @need 750
14150 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14151
14152 @smallexample
14153 Attaching remote machine across net...
14154 Connected to tt.
14155 @end smallexample
14156
14157 @need 1000
14158 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14159 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14160 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14161 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
14162 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14163
14164 @smallexample
14165 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14166 @end smallexample
14167
14168 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14169 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14170 command again.
14171
14172 @node VxWorks Download
14173 @subsubsection VxWorks download
14174
14175 @cindex download to VxWorks
14176 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14177 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14178 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14179 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14180 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14181 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14182 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14183 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14184 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14185 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14186 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14187 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14188 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14189 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14190 program, type this on VxWorks:
14191
14192 @smallexample
14193 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14194 @end smallexample
14195
14196 @noindent
14197 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14198
14199 @smallexample
14200 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14201 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14202 @end smallexample
14203
14204 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14205
14206 @smallexample
14207 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14208 @end smallexample
14209
14210 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14211 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14212 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14213 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14214 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14215 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14216 table.)
14217
14218 @node VxWorks Attach
14219 @subsubsection Running tasks
14220
14221 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14222 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14223 follows:
14224
14225 @smallexample
14226 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14227 @end smallexample
14228
14229 @noindent
14230 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14231 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14232 the time of attachment.
14233
14234 @node Embedded Processors
14235 @section Embedded Processors
14236
14237 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14238 configurations.
14239
14240 @cindex send command to simulator
14241 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14242 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14243
14244 @table @code
14245 @item sim @var{command}
14246 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14247 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14248 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14249 acceptable commands.
14250 @end table
14251
14252
14253 @menu
14254 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14255 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
14256 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
14257 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14258 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14259 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14260 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14261 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14262 * PowerPC: PowerPC
14263 * SH:: Renesas SH
14264 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14265 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14266 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
14267 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14268 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14269 * CRIS:: CRIS
14270 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14271 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
14272 @end menu
14273
14274 @node ARM
14275 @subsection ARM
14276 @cindex ARM RDI
14277
14278 @table @code
14279 @kindex target rdi
14280 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14281 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14282 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14283 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14284
14285 @kindex target rdp
14286 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14287 ARM Demon monitor.
14288
14289 @end table
14290
14291 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14292
14293 @table @code
14294 @item set arm disassembler
14295 @kindex set arm
14296 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14297 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14298
14299 @item show arm disassembler
14300 @kindex show arm
14301 Show the current disassembly style.
14302
14303 @item set arm apcs32
14304 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14305 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14306
14307 @item show arm apcs32
14308 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14309
14310 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14311 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14312 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14313
14314 @table @code
14315 @item auto
14316 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14317 @item softfpa
14318 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14319 processors.
14320 @item fpa
14321 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14322 @item softvfp
14323 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14324 @item vfp
14325 VFP co-processor.
14326 @end table
14327
14328 @item show arm fpu
14329 Show the current type of the FPU.
14330
14331 @item set arm abi
14332 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14333
14334 @item show arm abi
14335 Show the currently used ABI.
14336
14337 @item set debug arm
14338 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14339 target support subsystem.
14340
14341 @item show debug arm
14342 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14343 @end table
14344
14345 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14346 using the RDI interface:
14347
14348 @table @code
14349 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14350 @kindex rdilogfile
14351 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14352 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14353 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14354 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14355 @file{rdi.log}.
14356
14357 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14358 @kindex rdilogenable
14359 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14360 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14361 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14362 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14363 are logged to a file.
14364
14365 @item set rdiromatzero
14366 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14367 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14368 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14369 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14370 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14371 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14372
14373 @item show rdiromatzero
14374 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14375 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14376
14377 @item set rdiheartbeat
14378 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14379 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14380 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14381 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14382 well as the Angel monitor.
14383
14384 @item show rdiheartbeat
14385 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14386 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14387 @end table
14388
14389
14390 @node H8/300
14391 @subsection Renesas H8/300
14392
14393 @table @code
14394
14395 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
14396 @item target hms @var{dev}
14397 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
14398 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
14399 line and the communications speed used.
14400
14401 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
14402 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14403 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
14404
14405 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
14406 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
14407 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14408 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
14409 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14410
14411 @end table
14412
14413 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
14414 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
14415 @cindex download to Renesas SH
14416 @cindex Renesas SH download
14417 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
14418 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
14419 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
14420 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
14421
14422 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
14423 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
14424
14425 @enumerate
14426 @item
14427 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
14428 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
14429 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
14430 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
14431 H8/300, or H8/500.)
14432
14433 @item
14434 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
14435 serial device available on your host is the default).
14436
14437 @item
14438 what speed to use over the serial device.
14439 @end enumerate
14440
14441 @menu
14442 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
14443 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
14444 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
14445 @end menu
14446
14447 @node Renesas Boards
14448 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
14449
14450 @c only for Unix hosts
14451 @kindex device
14452 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
14453 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
14454 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
14455 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
14456 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
14457
14458 @kindex speed
14459 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
14460 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
14461 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
14462 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
14463 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
14464 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
14465
14466 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
14467 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
14468 use a DOS host,
14469 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
14470 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
14471 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
14472 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
14473
14474 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
14475 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
14476 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
14477 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
14478
14479 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
14480 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
14481 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
14482 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
14483 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
14484 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
14485 @code{COM2}.
14486
14487 @smallexample
14488 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
14489 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
14490
14491 Resident portion of MODE loaded
14492
14493 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
14494
14495 @end smallexample
14496
14497 @quotation
14498 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
14499 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
14500 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
14501 your development board.
14502 @end quotation
14503
14504 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
14505 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
14506 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
14507 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
14508 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
14509 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
14510 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
14511 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
14512 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
14513 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
14514 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
14515 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
14516 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
14517
14518 @smallexample
14519 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
14520 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
14521 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
14522 the conditions.
14523 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
14524 for details.
14525 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
14526 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
14527 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
14528 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
14529 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
14530 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
14531 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
14532 @end smallexample
14533
14534 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
14535 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
14536 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
14537 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
14538 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
14539 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
14540
14541 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
14542 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
14543 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
14544
14545 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
14546 @itemize @bullet
14547 @item
14548 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{Ctrl-c} on the DOS host---it has
14549 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
14550
14551 @item
14552 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
14553 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
14554 to detect program completion.
14555 @end itemize
14556
14557 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
14558 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
14559
14560 @node Renesas ICE
14561 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
14562
14563 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
14564 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
14565 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
14566 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
14567
14568 @table @code
14569 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
14570 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
14571 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
14572 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
14573 (for example, @samp{9600}).
14574
14575 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
14576 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
14577 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
14578 @end table
14579
14580 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
14581 Renesas E7000 ICE:
14582
14583 @table @code
14584 @item e7000 @var{command}
14585 @kindex e7000
14586 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
14587 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
14588
14589 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
14590 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
14591 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
14592 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
14593 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
14594 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
14595
14596 @item ftpload @var{file}
14597 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
14598 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
14599 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
14600
14601 @item drain
14602 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
14603 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
14604
14605 @item set usehardbreakpoints
14606 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
14607 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14608 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14609 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
14610 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
14611 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
14612 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
14613 @end table
14614
14615 @node Renesas Special
14616 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
14617
14618 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
14619
14620 @table @code
14621
14622 @kindex set machine
14623 @kindex show machine
14624 @item set machine h8300
14625 @itemx set machine h8300h
14626 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
14627 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
14628 to check which variant is currently in effect.
14629
14630 @end table
14631
14632 @node H8/500
14633 @subsection H8/500
14634
14635 @table @code
14636
14637 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
14638 @cindex memory models, H8/500
14639 @item set memory @var{mod}
14640 @itemx show memory
14641 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
14642 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
14643 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
14644 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
14645
14646 @end table
14647
14648 @node M32R/D
14649 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14650
14651 @table @code
14652 @kindex target m32r
14653 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14654 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14655
14656 @kindex target m32rsdi
14657 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14658 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14659 @end table
14660
14661 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14662
14663 @table @code
14664 @item set download-path @var{path}
14665 @kindex set download-path
14666 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14667 Set the default path for finding donwloadable @sc{srec} files.
14668
14669 @item show download-path
14670 @kindex show download-path
14671 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14672
14673 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14674 @kindex set board-address
14675 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14676 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14677
14678 @item show board-address
14679 @kindex show board-address
14680 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14681
14682 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14683 @kindex set server-address
14684 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14685 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14686 host machine.
14687
14688 @item show server-address
14689 @kindex show server-address
14690 Display the IP address of the download server.
14691
14692 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14693 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14694 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14695 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14696 executable file is uploaded.
14697
14698 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14699 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14700 Test the @code{upload} command.
14701 @end table
14702
14703 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14704
14705 @table @code
14706 @item sdireset
14707 @kindex sdireset
14708 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14709 This command resets the SDI connection.
14710
14711 @item sdistatus
14712 @kindex sdistatus
14713 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14714
14715 @item debug_chaos
14716 @kindex debug_chaos
14717 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14718 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14719
14720 @item use_debug_dma
14721 @kindex use_debug_dma
14722 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14723
14724 @item use_mon_code
14725 @kindex use_mon_code
14726 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14727
14728 @item use_ib_break
14729 @kindex use_ib_break
14730 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14731
14732 @item use_dbt_break
14733 @kindex use_dbt_break
14734 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14735 @end table
14736
14737 @node M68K
14738 @subsection M68k
14739
14740 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14741 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14742
14743 @table @code
14744
14745 @kindex target abug
14746 @item target abug @var{dev}
14747 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14748
14749 @kindex target cpu32bug
14750 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14751 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14752
14753 @kindex target dbug
14754 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14755 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14756
14757 @kindex target est
14758 @item target est @var{dev}
14759 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14760
14761 @kindex target rom68k
14762 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14763 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14764
14765 @end table
14766
14767 @table @code
14768
14769 @kindex target rombug
14770 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14771 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14772
14773 @end table
14774
14775 @node MIPS Embedded
14776 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14777
14778 @cindex MIPS boards
14779 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14780 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14781 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14782
14783 @need 1000
14784 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14785
14786 @table @code
14787 @item target mips @var{port}
14788 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14789 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14790 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14791 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14792 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14793 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14794 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14795
14796 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14797 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14798 debugger:
14799
14800 @smallexample
14801 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14802 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14803 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14804 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14805 (@value{GDBP}) run
14806 @end smallexample
14807
14808 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14809 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14810 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14811 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14812 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14813
14814 @item target pmon @var{port}
14815 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14816 PMON ROM monitor.
14817
14818 @item target ddb @var{port}
14819 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14820 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14821
14822 @item target lsi @var{port}
14823 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14824 LSI variant of PMON.
14825
14826 @kindex target r3900
14827 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14828 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14829
14830 @kindex target array
14831 @item target array @var{dev}
14832 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14833
14834 @end table
14835
14836
14837 @noindent
14838 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14839
14840 @table @code
14841 @item set mipsfpu double
14842 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14843 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14844 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14845 @itemx show mipsfpu
14846 @kindex set mipsfpu
14847 @kindex show mipsfpu
14848 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14849 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14850 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14851 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14852 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14853 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14854 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14855 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14856 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14857 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14858 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14859 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14860 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14861
14862 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14863 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14864 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14865
14866 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14867 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14868
14869 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14870 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14871 @itemx show timeout
14872 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14873 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14874 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14875 @kindex set timeout
14876 @kindex show timeout
14877 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14878 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14879 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14880 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14881 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14882 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14883 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14884 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14885 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14886 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14887
14888 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14889 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14890 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14891 to run before stopping.
14892
14893 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14894 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14895 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14896 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14897 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14898 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14899
14900 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14901 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14902 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14903 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14904
14905 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14906 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14907 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14908 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14909 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14910 @table @asis
14911 @item pmon target
14912 @samp{PMON}
14913 @item ddb target
14914 @samp{NEC010}
14915 @item lsi target
14916 @samp{PMON>}
14917 @end table
14918
14919 @item show monitor-prompt
14920 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14921 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14922 remote monitor.
14923
14924 @item set monitor-warnings
14925 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14926 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14927 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14928 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14929 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14930
14931 @item show monitor-warnings
14932 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14933 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14934
14935 @item pmon @var{command}
14936 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14937 @cindex send PMON command
14938 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14939 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14940 @end table
14941
14942 @node OpenRISC 1000
14943 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14944 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14945
14946 @cindex or1k boards
14947 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14948 about platform and commands.
14949
14950 @table @code
14951
14952 @kindex target jtag
14953 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14954
14955 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14956 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14957 connected via parallel port to the board.
14958
14959 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14960
14961 @kindex or1ksim
14962 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14963 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14964 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14965
14966 @kindex info or1k spr
14967 @item info or1k spr
14968 Displays spr groups.
14969
14970 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14971 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14972 Displays register names in selected group.
14973
14974 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14975 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14976 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14977 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14978 Shows information about specified spr register.
14979
14980 @kindex spr
14981 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14982 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14983 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14984 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14985 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14986 @end table
14987
14988 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14989 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14990 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14991 triggers can be set using:
14992 @table @code
14993 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14994 Load effective address/data
14995 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14996 Store effective address/data
14997 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14998 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14999 @item $FETCH
15000 Fetch data
15001 @end table
15002
15003 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15004 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15005
15006 @code{htrace} commands:
15007 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15008 @table @code
15009 @kindex hwatch
15010 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15011 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
15012 or Data. For example:
15013
15014 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15015
15016 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15017
15018 @kindex htrace
15019 @item htrace info
15020 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15021
15022 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15023 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15024
15025 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15026 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15027
15028 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15029 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15030
15031 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15032 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15033 triggered.
15034
15035 @item htrace enable
15036 @itemx htrace disable
15037 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15038
15039 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15040 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15041
15042 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15043 will be written there.
15044
15045 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15046 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15047
15048 @item htrace mode continuous
15049 Set continuous trace mode.
15050
15051 @item htrace mode suspend
15052 Set suspend trace mode.
15053
15054 @end table
15055
15056 @node PowerPC
15057 @subsection PowerPC
15058
15059 @table @code
15060 @kindex target dink32
15061 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15062 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15063
15064 @kindex target ppcbug
15065 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15066 @kindex target ppcbug1
15067 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15068 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15069
15070 @kindex target sds
15071 @item target sds @var{dev}
15072 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15073 @end table
15074
15075 @cindex SDS protocol
15076 The following commands specifi to the SDS protocol are supported
15077 by@value{GDBN}:
15078
15079 @table @code
15080 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15081 @kindex set sdstimeout
15082 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15083 default is 2 seconds.
15084
15085 @item show sdstimeout
15086 @kindex show sdstimeout
15087 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15088
15089 @item sds @var{command}
15090 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15091 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15092 @end table
15093
15094
15095 @node PA
15096 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15097
15098 @table @code
15099
15100 @kindex target op50n
15101 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15102 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15103
15104 @kindex target w89k
15105 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15106 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15107
15108 @end table
15109
15110 @node SH
15111 @subsection Renesas SH
15112
15113 @table @code
15114
15115 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
15116 @item target hms @var{dev}
15117 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
15118 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
15119 the communications speed used.
15120
15121 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
15122 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
15123 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
15124
15125 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
15126 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
15127 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
15128 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
15129 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
15130
15131 @end table
15132
15133 @node Sparclet
15134 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15135
15136 @cindex Sparclet
15137
15138 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15139 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15140 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15141 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15142 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15143
15144 @table @code
15145 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15146 @kindex remotetimeout
15147 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15148 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15149 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15150 @end table
15151
15152 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15153 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15154 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15155 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15156 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15157
15158 @smallexample
15159 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15160 @end smallexample
15161
15162 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15163
15164 @smallexample
15165 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15166 @end smallexample
15167
15168 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15169 Once you have set
15170 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15171 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15172 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15173
15174 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15175
15176 @smallexample
15177 (gdbslet)
15178 @end smallexample
15179
15180 @menu
15181 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15182 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15183 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15184 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15185 @end menu
15186
15187 @node Sparclet File
15188 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
15189
15190 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15191
15192 @smallexample
15193 (gdbslet) file prog
15194 @end smallexample
15195
15196 @need 1000
15197 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15198 @value{GDBN} locates
15199 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15200 path.
15201 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
15202 files will be searched as well.
15203 @value{GDBN} locates
15204 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15205 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
15206 If it fails
15207 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15208
15209 @smallexample
15210 prog: No such file or directory.
15211 @end smallexample
15212
15213 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15214 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15215 @code{target} command again.
15216
15217 @node Sparclet Connection
15218 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15219
15220 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15221 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15222
15223 @smallexample
15224 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15225 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15226 main () at ../prog.c:3
15227 @end smallexample
15228
15229 @need 750
15230 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15231
15232 @smallexample
15233 Connected to ttya.
15234 @end smallexample
15235
15236 @node Sparclet Download
15237 @subsubsection Sparclet download
15238
15239 @cindex download to Sparclet
15240 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15241 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15242 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15243 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15244 command.
15245 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15246 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15247 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15248 of each of the file's sections.
15249 For instance, if the program
15250 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15251 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15252
15253 @smallexample
15254 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15255 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15256 @end smallexample
15257
15258 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15259 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15260 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15261
15262 @node Sparclet Execution
15263 @subsubsection Running and debugging
15264
15265 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15266 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15267 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15268 manual for the list of commands.
15269
15270 @smallexample
15271 (gdbslet) b main
15272 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15273 (gdbslet) run
15274 Starting program: prog
15275 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15276 3 char *symarg = 0;
15277 (gdbslet) step
15278 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15279 (gdbslet)
15280 @end smallexample
15281
15282 @node Sparclite
15283 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15284
15285 @table @code
15286
15287 @kindex target sparclite
15288 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15289 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15290 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15291 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15292 remote protocol.
15293
15294 @end table
15295
15296 @node ST2000
15297 @subsection Tandem ST2000
15298
15299 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
15300 STDBUG protocol.
15301
15302 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
15303 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
15304
15305 @smallexample
15306 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
15307 @end smallexample
15308
15309 @noindent
15310 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
15311 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
15312 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
15313 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
15314 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15315
15316 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
15317 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
15318 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
15319 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
15320 available on your host computer.
15321 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
15322 @c basically hearsay.
15323
15324 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
15325 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
15326 environment:
15327
15328 @table @code
15329 @item st2000 @var{command}
15330 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
15331 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
15332 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
15333 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
15334 manual for available commands.
15335
15336 @item connect
15337 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
15338 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
15339 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
15340 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
15341 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ .} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
15342 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ Ctrl-d} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
15343 @end table
15344
15345 @node Z8000
15346 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15347
15348 @cindex Z8000
15349 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15350 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15351
15352 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15353 a Z8000 simulator.
15354
15355 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15356 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15357 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15358 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15359
15360 @table @code
15361 @item target sim @var{args}
15362 @kindex sim
15363 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15364 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15365 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15366 @end table
15367
15368 @noindent
15369 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15370 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15371 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15372 to run your program, and so on.
15373
15374 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15375 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15376 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15377
15378 @table @code
15379
15380 @item cycles
15381 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15382
15383 @item insts
15384 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15385
15386 @item time
15387 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15388
15389 @end table
15390
15391 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15392 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15393 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15394 simulated clock ticks.
15395
15396 @node AVR
15397 @subsection Atmel AVR
15398 @cindex AVR
15399
15400 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15401 following AVR-specific commands:
15402
15403 @table @code
15404 @item info io_registers
15405 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15406 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15407 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15408 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15409 @end table
15410
15411 @node CRIS
15412 @subsection CRIS
15413 @cindex CRIS
15414
15415 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15416 following CRIS-specific commands:
15417
15418 @table @code
15419 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15420 @cindex CRIS version
15421 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15422 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15423 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15424
15425 @item show cris-version
15426 Show the current CRIS version.
15427
15428 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15429 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15430 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15431 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15432 @code{R59}.
15433
15434 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15435 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15436
15437 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15438 @cindex CRIS mode
15439 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15440 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15441 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15442
15443 @item show cris-mode
15444 Show the current CRIS mode.
15445 @end table
15446
15447 @node Super-H
15448 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15449 @cindex Super-H
15450
15451 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15452 commands:
15453
15454 @table @code
15455 @item regs
15456 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15457 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15458 @end table
15459
15460 @node WinCE
15461 @subsection Windows CE
15462 @cindex Windows CE
15463
15464 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
15465
15466 @table @code
15467 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
15468 @kindex set remotedirectory
15469 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
15470 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
15471 drive.
15472
15473 @item show remotedirectory
15474 @kindex show remotedirectory
15475 Show the current value of the upload directory.
15476
15477 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
15478 @kindex set remoteupload
15479 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
15480 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
15481 The default is @samp{newer}.
15482
15483 @item show remoteupload
15484 @kindex show remoteupload
15485 Show the current setting of the upload method.
15486
15487 @item set remoteaddhost
15488 @kindex set remoteaddhost
15489 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
15490 arguments when you debug over a network.
15491
15492 @item show remoteaddhost
15493 @kindex show remoteaddhost
15494 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
15495 debugging over a network.
15496 @end table
15497
15498
15499 @node Architectures
15500 @section Architectures
15501
15502 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15503 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15504
15505 @menu
15506 * i386::
15507 * A29K::
15508 * Alpha::
15509 * MIPS::
15510 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15511 @end menu
15512
15513 @node i386
15514 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
15515
15516 @table @code
15517 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15518 @kindex set struct-convention
15519 @cindex struct return convention
15520 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15521 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15522 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15523 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15524 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15525 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15526 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15527 be returned in a register.
15528
15529 @item show struct-convention
15530 @kindex show struct-convention
15531 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15532 from functions.
15533 @end table
15534
15535 @node A29K
15536 @subsection A29K
15537
15538 @table @code
15539
15540 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15541 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15542 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15543 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15544 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15545 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15546 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15547 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15548 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15549 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15550 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15551 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15552 hexadecimal.
15553
15554 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15555 @item show rstack_high_address
15556 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15557 processors.
15558
15559 @end table
15560
15561 @node Alpha
15562 @subsection Alpha
15563
15564 See the following section.
15565
15566 @node MIPS
15567 @subsection MIPS
15568
15569 @cindex stack on Alpha
15570 @cindex stack on MIPS
15571 @cindex Alpha stack
15572 @cindex MIPS stack
15573 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15574 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15575 find the beginning of a function.
15576
15577 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15578 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15579 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15580 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15581 commands:
15582
15583 @table @code
15584 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15585 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15586 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15587 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15588 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15589 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15590 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15591 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15592
15593 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15594 Display the current limit.
15595 @end table
15596
15597 @noindent
15598 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15599 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15600
15601 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15602 programs:
15603
15604 @table @code
15605 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15606 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15607 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15608 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15609 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15610
15611 @table @samp
15612 @item 32
15613 32-bit GP registers
15614 @item 64
15615 64-bit GP registers
15616 @item auto
15617 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15618 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15619 @end table
15620
15621 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15622 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15623 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15624
15625 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15626 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15627 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15628 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15629 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15630 (the default).
15631
15632 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15633 @kindex set mips abi
15634 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15635 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15636 values of @var{arg} are:
15637
15638 @table @samp
15639 @item auto
15640 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15641 default).
15642 @item o32
15643 @item o64
15644 @item n32
15645 @item n64
15646 @item eabi32
15647 @item eabi64
15648 @item auto
15649 @end table
15650
15651 @item show mips abi
15652 @kindex show mips abi
15653 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15654
15655 @item set mipsfpu
15656 @itemx show mipsfpu
15657 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15658
15659 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15660 @kindex set mips mask-address
15661 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15662 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15663 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15664 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15665 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15666
15667 @item show mips mask-address
15668 @kindex show mips mask-address
15669 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15670 not.
15671
15672 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15673 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15674 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15675 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15676 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15677 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15678
15679 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15680 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15681 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15682
15683 @item set debug mips
15684 @kindex set debug mips
15685 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15686 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15687
15688 @item show debug mips
15689 @kindex show debug mips
15690 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15691 @end table
15692
15693
15694 @node HPPA
15695 @subsection HPPA
15696 @cindex HPPA support
15697
15698 When @value{GDBN} is debugging te HP PA architecture, it provides the
15699 following special commands:
15700
15701 @table @code
15702 @item set debug hppa
15703 @kindex set debug hppa
15704 THis command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15705 messages are to be displayed.
15706
15707 @item show debug hppa
15708 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15709
15710 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15711 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15712 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15713 given @var{address}.
15714
15715 @end table
15716
15717
15718 @node Controlling GDB
15719 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15720
15721 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15722 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15723 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15724 described here.
15725
15726 @menu
15727 * Prompt:: Prompt
15728 * Editing:: Command editing
15729 * Command History:: Command history
15730 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15731 * Numbers:: Numbers
15732 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15733 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15734 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15735 @end menu
15736
15737 @node Prompt
15738 @section Prompt
15739
15740 @cindex prompt
15741
15742 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15743 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15744 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15745 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15746 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15747 which one you are talking to.
15748
15749 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15750 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15751 or a prompt that does not.
15752
15753 @table @code
15754 @kindex set prompt
15755 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15756 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15757
15758 @kindex show prompt
15759 @item show prompt
15760 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15761 @end table
15762
15763 @node Editing
15764 @section Command editing
15765 @cindex readline
15766 @cindex command line editing
15767
15768 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15769 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15770 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15771 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15772 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15773 debugging sessions.
15774
15775 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15776 command @code{set}.
15777
15778 @table @code
15779 @kindex set editing
15780 @cindex editing
15781 @item set editing
15782 @itemx set editing on
15783 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15784
15785 @item set editing off
15786 Disable command line editing.
15787
15788 @kindex show editing
15789 @item show editing
15790 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15791 @end table
15792
15793 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15794 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15795 encouraged to read that chapter.
15796
15797 @node Command History
15798 @section Command history
15799 @cindex command history
15800
15801 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15802 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15803 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15804 history facility.
15805
15806 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15807 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15808 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15809
15810 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15811 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15812 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15813 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15814 pressed on a line by itself.
15815
15816 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15817 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15818 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15819 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15820
15821 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15822 history.
15823
15824 @table @code
15825 @cindex history substitution
15826 @cindex history file
15827 @kindex set history filename
15828 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15829 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15830 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15831 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15832 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15833 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15834 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15835 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15836 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15837 is not set.
15838
15839 @cindex save command history
15840 @kindex set history save
15841 @item set history save
15842 @itemx set history save on
15843 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15844 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15845
15846 @item set history save off
15847 Stop recording command history in a file.
15848
15849 @cindex history size
15850 @kindex set history size
15851 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15852 @item set history size @var{size}
15853 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15854 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15855 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15856 @end table
15857
15858 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15859 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15860
15861 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15862 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15863 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15864 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15865 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15866 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15867 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15868 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15869
15870 The commands to control history expansion are:
15871
15872 @table @code
15873 @item set history expansion on
15874 @itemx set history expansion
15875 @kindex set history expansion
15876 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15877
15878 @item set history expansion off
15879 Disable history expansion.
15880
15881 @c @group
15882 @kindex show history
15883 @item show history
15884 @itemx show history filename
15885 @itemx show history save
15886 @itemx show history size
15887 @itemx show history expansion
15888 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15889 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15890 @c @end group
15891 @end table
15892
15893 @table @code
15894 @kindex show commands
15895 @cindex show last commands
15896 @cindex display command history
15897 @item show commands
15898 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15899
15900 @item show commands @var{n}
15901 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15902
15903 @item show commands +
15904 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15905 @end table
15906
15907 @node Screen Size
15908 @section Screen size
15909 @cindex size of screen
15910 @cindex pauses in output
15911
15912 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15913 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15914 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15915 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15916 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15917 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15918 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15919 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15920
15921 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15922 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15923 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15924 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15925 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15926 width} commands:
15927
15928 @table @code
15929 @kindex set height
15930 @kindex set width
15931 @kindex show width
15932 @kindex show height
15933 @item set height @var{lpp}
15934 @itemx show height
15935 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15936 @itemx show width
15937 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15938 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15939 commands display the current settings.
15940
15941 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15942 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15943 file or to an editor buffer.
15944
15945 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15946 from wrapping its output.
15947
15948 @item set pagination on
15949 @itemx set pagination off
15950 @kindex set pagination
15951 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15952 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15953
15954 @item show pagination
15955 @kindex show pagination
15956 Show the current pagination mode.
15957 @end table
15958
15959 @node Numbers
15960 @section Numbers
15961 @cindex number representation
15962 @cindex entering numbers
15963
15964 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15965 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15966 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15967 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15968 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15969 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15970 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15971 both input and output with the commands described below.
15972
15973 @table @code
15974 @kindex set input-radix
15975 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15976 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15977 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15978 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15979 example, any of
15980
15981 @smallexample
15982 set input-radix 012
15983 set input-radix 10.
15984 set input-radix 0xa
15985 @end smallexample
15986
15987 @noindent
15988 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15989 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15990 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15991 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15992 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15993 change the radix.
15994
15995 @kindex set output-radix
15996 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15997 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15998 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15999 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16000
16001 @kindex show input-radix
16002 @item show input-radix
16003 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16004
16005 @kindex show output-radix
16006 @item show output-radix
16007 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16008
16009 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16010 @itemx show radix
16011 @kindex set radix
16012 @kindex show radix
16013 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16014 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16015 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16016 default value of 10.
16017
16018 @end table
16019
16020 @node ABI
16021 @section Configuring the current ABI
16022
16023 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16024 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16025 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16026 current ABI.
16027
16028 @cindex OS ABI
16029 @kindex set osabi
16030 @kindex show osabi
16031
16032 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16033 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16034 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16035 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16036 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16037 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16038 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16039 platform provides.
16040
16041 @table @code
16042 @item show osabi
16043 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16044
16045 @item set osabi
16046 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16047
16048 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16049 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16050 @end table
16051
16052 @cindex float promotion
16053
16054 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16055 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16056 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16057 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16058 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16059 @code{double} and then passed.
16060
16061 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16062 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16063 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16064
16065 @table @code
16066 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16067 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16068 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16069 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16070 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16071
16072 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16073 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16074 functions.
16075
16076 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16077 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16078 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16079 @end table
16080
16081 @kindex set cp-abi
16082 @kindex show cp-abi
16083 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16084 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16085 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16086 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16087 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16088 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16089 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16090 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16091 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16092 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16093 ``auto''.
16094
16095 @table @code
16096 @item show cp-abi
16097 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16098
16099 @item set cp-abi
16100 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16101
16102 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16103 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16104 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16105 @end table
16106
16107 @node Messages/Warnings
16108 @section Optional warnings and messages
16109
16110 @cindex verbose operation
16111 @cindex optional warnings
16112 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16113 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16114 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16115 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16116
16117 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16118 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16119 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
16120
16121 @table @code
16122 @kindex set verbose
16123 @item set verbose on
16124 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16125
16126 @item set verbose off
16127 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16128
16129 @kindex show verbose
16130 @item show verbose
16131 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16132 @end table
16133
16134 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16135 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16136 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
16137 symbol files}).
16138
16139 @table @code
16140
16141 @kindex set complaints
16142 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16143 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16144 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16145 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16146 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16147
16148 @kindex show complaints
16149 @item show complaints
16150 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16151
16152 @end table
16153
16154 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16155 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16156 you try to run a program which is already running:
16157
16158 @smallexample
16159 (@value{GDBP}) run
16160 The program being debugged has been started already.
16161 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16162 @end smallexample
16163
16164 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16165 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16166
16167 @table @code
16168
16169 @kindex set confirm
16170 @cindex flinching
16171 @cindex confirmation
16172 @cindex stupid questions
16173 @item set confirm off
16174 Disables confirmation requests.
16175
16176 @item set confirm on
16177 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16178
16179 @kindex show confirm
16180 @item show confirm
16181 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16182
16183 @end table
16184
16185 @cindex command tracing
16186 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16187 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16188 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16189 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16190
16191 @table @code
16192 @kindex set trace-commands
16193 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16194 @item set trace-commands on
16195 Enable command tracing.
16196 @item set trace-commands off
16197 Disable command tracing.
16198 @item show trace-commands
16199 Display the current state of command tracing.
16200 @end table
16201
16202 @node Debugging Output
16203 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
16204 @cindex optional debugging messages
16205
16206 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16207 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16208 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16209 section documents those commands.
16210
16211 @table @code
16212 @kindex set exec-done-display
16213 @item set exec-done-display
16214 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16215 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16216 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16217 @kindex show exec-done-display
16218 @item show exec-done-display
16219 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16220 notification.
16221 @kindex set debug
16222 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16223 @cindex architecture debugging info
16224 @item set debug arch
16225 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16226 @kindex show debug
16227 @item show debug arch
16228 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16229 @item set debug aix-thread
16230 @cindex AIX threads
16231 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16232 module.
16233 @item show debug aix-thread
16234 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16235 @item set debug event
16236 @cindex event debugging info
16237 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16238 default is off.
16239 @item show debug event
16240 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16241 info.
16242 @item set debug expression
16243 @cindex expression debugging info
16244 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16245 expression parsing. The default is off.
16246 @item show debug expression
16247 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16248 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16249 @item set debug frame
16250 @cindex frame debugging info
16251 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16252 default is off.
16253 @item show debug frame
16254 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16255 info.
16256 @item set debug infrun
16257 @cindex inferior debugging info
16258 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16259 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16260 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16261 @item show debug infrun
16262 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16263 @item set debug lin-lwp
16264 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16265 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16266 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16267 @item show debug lin-lwp
16268 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16269 @item set debug observer
16270 @cindex observer debugging info
16271 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16272 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16273 @item show debug observer
16274 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16275 @item set debug overload
16276 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16277 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16278 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16279 is off.
16280 @item show debug overload
16281 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16282 debugging info.
16283 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16284 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16285 @cindex debug remote protocol
16286 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16287 @cindex display remote packets
16288 @item set debug remote
16289 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16290 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16291 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16292 @item show debug remote
16293 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16294 @item set debug serial
16295 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16296 default is off.
16297 @item show debug serial
16298 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16299 info.
16300 @item set debug solib-frv
16301 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16302 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16303 @item show debug solib-frv
16304 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16305 messages.
16306 @item set debug target
16307 @cindex target debugging info
16308 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16309 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16310 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16311 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16312 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16313 @item show debug target
16314 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16315 info.
16316 @item set debugvarobj
16317 @cindex variable object debugging info
16318 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16319 info. The default is off.
16320 @item show debugvarobj
16321 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16322 debugging info.
16323 @item set debug xml
16324 @cindex XML parser debugging
16325 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16326 @item show debug xml
16327 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16328 @end table
16329
16330 @node Sequences
16331 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16332
16333 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16334 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16335 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16336 files.
16337
16338 @menu
16339 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16340 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16341 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16342 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16343 @end menu
16344
16345 @node Define
16346 @section User-defined commands
16347
16348 @cindex user-defined command
16349 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16350 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16351 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16352 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16353 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16354 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16355
16356 @smallexample
16357 define adder
16358 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16359 end
16360 @end smallexample
16361
16362 @noindent
16363 To execute the command use:
16364
16365 @smallexample
16366 adder 1 2 3
16367 @end smallexample
16368
16369 @noindent
16370 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16371 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16372 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16373 functions calls.
16374
16375 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16376 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16377 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16378 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16379
16380 @smallexample
16381 define adder
16382 if $argc == 2
16383 print $arg0 + $arg1
16384 end
16385 if $argc == 3
16386 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16387 end
16388 end
16389 @end smallexample
16390
16391 @table @code
16392
16393 @kindex define
16394 @item define @var{commandname}
16395 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16396 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16397
16398 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16399 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16400 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16401
16402 @kindex document
16403 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16404 @item document @var{commandname}
16405 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16406 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16407 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16408 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16409 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16410 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16411
16412 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16413 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16414 does not change the documentation.
16415
16416 @kindex dont-repeat
16417 @cindex don't repeat command
16418 @item dont-repeat
16419 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16420 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16421 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16422
16423 @kindex help user-defined
16424 @item help user-defined
16425 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16426 (if any) for each.
16427
16428 @kindex show user
16429 @item show user
16430 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16431 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16432 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16433 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16434
16435 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16436 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16437 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16438 @item show max-user-call-depth
16439 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16440 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16441 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
16442 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16443 @end table
16444
16445 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16446 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16447
16448 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16449 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16450 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16451
16452 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16453 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16454 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16455 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16456
16457 @node Hooks
16458 @section User-defined command hooks
16459 @cindex command hooks
16460 @cindex hooks, for commands
16461 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16462
16463 @kindex hook
16464 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16465 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16466 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16467 before that command.
16468
16469 @cindex hooks, post-command
16470 @kindex hookpost
16471 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16472 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16473 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16474 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16475 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16476
16477 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16478 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16479
16480 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16481 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16482
16483 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16484 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16485 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16486 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16487 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16488
16489 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16490 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16491 you could define:
16492
16493 @smallexample
16494 define hook-stop
16495 handle SIGALRM nopass
16496 end
16497
16498 define hook-run
16499 handle SIGALRM pass
16500 end
16501
16502 define hook-continue
16503 handle SIGLARM pass
16504 end
16505 @end smallexample
16506
16507 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
16508 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16509 you could define:
16510
16511 @smallexample
16512 define hook-echo
16513 echo <<<---
16514 end
16515
16516 define hookpost-echo
16517 echo --->>>\n
16518 end
16519
16520 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16521 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16522 (@value{GDBP})
16523
16524 @end smallexample
16525
16526 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16527 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16528 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16529 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16530 @c or not?
16531 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16532 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16533 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16534
16535 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16536 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16537
16538 @node Command Files
16539 @section Command files
16540
16541 @cindex command files
16542 @cindex scripting commands
16543 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16544 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16545 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16546 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16547 terminal.
16548
16549 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16550 command:
16551
16552 @table @code
16553 @kindex source
16554 @cindex execute commands from a file
16555 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16556 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16557 @end table
16558
16559 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16560 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16561 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16562 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16563 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16564
16565 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16566 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16567
16568 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16569 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16570 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16571
16572 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16573 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16574 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16575 when called from command files.
16576
16577 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16578 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16579 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16580 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16581 the next command.
16582
16583 @smallexample
16584 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16585 @end smallexample
16586
16587 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16588 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16589 would be directed to @file{log}.
16590
16591 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16592 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16593 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16594 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16595 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16596 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16597 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16598 conditionally, etc.
16599
16600 @table @code
16601 @kindex if
16602 @kindex else
16603 @item if
16604 @itemx else
16605 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16606 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16607 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16608 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16609 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16610 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16611 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16612
16613 @kindex while
16614 @item while
16615 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16616 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16617 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16618 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16619 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16620 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16621
16622 @kindex loop_break
16623 @item loop_break
16624 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16625 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16626 line.
16627
16628 @kindex loop_continue
16629 @item loop_continue
16630 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16631 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16632 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16633 the controlling expression.
16634
16635 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16636 @item end
16637 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16638 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16639 @end table
16640
16641
16642 @node Output
16643 @section Commands for controlled output
16644
16645 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16646 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16647 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16648 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16649 want.
16650
16651 @table @code
16652 @kindex echo
16653 @item echo @var{text}
16654 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16655 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16656 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16657 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16658 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16659 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16660 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16661 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16662 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16663 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16664 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16665
16666 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16667 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16668
16669 @smallexample
16670 echo This is some text\n\
16671 which is continued\n\
16672 onto several lines.\n
16673 @end smallexample
16674
16675 produces the same output as
16676
16677 @smallexample
16678 echo This is some text\n
16679 echo which is continued\n
16680 echo onto several lines.\n
16681 @end smallexample
16682
16683 @kindex output
16684 @item output @var{expression}
16685 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16686 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16687 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16688 on expressions.
16689
16690 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16691 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16692 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16693 formats}, for more information.
16694
16695 @kindex printf
16696 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16697 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16698 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16699 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16700 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16701 subroutine
16702 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16703 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16704 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16705 @c supported.
16706
16707 @smallexample
16708 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16709 @end smallexample
16710
16711 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16712
16713 @smallexample
16714 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16715 @end smallexample
16716
16717 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16718 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16719 letter.
16720 @end table
16721
16722 @node Interpreters
16723 @chapter Command Interpreters
16724 @cindex command interpreters
16725
16726 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16727 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16728 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16729
16730 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16731 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16732 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16733 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16734
16735 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16736 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16737 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16738 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16739
16740 @table @code
16741 @item console
16742 @cindex console interpreter
16743 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16744 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16745 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16746
16747 @item mi
16748 @cindex mi interpreter
16749 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16750 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16751 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16752 Interface}.
16753
16754 @item mi2
16755 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16756 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16757
16758 @item mi1
16759 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16760 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16761
16762 @end table
16763
16764 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16765 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16766 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16767 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16768 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16769 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16770 the IDE inoperable!
16771
16772 @kindex interpreter-exec
16773 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16774 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16775 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16776 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16777
16778 @smallexample
16779 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16780 @end smallexample
16781
16782 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16783 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16784
16785 @node TUI
16786 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16787 @cindex TUI
16788 @cindex Text User Interface
16789
16790 @menu
16791 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16792 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16793 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16794 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16795 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16796 @end menu
16797
16798 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16799 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16800 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16801 commands in separate text windows.
16802
16803 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16804 @pindex gdbtui
16805 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16806
16807 @node TUI Overview
16808 @section TUI overview
16809
16810 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16811 @value{GDBN} runs:
16812
16813 @itemize @bullet
16814 @item
16815 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16816 windows on the terminal.
16817
16818 @item
16819 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16820 the TUI.
16821 @end itemize
16822
16823 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16824 on the terminal:
16825
16826 @table @emph
16827 @item command
16828 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16829 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16830 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16831 window is always visible.
16832
16833 @item source
16834 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16835 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16836
16837 @item assembly
16838 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16839
16840 @item register
16841 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16842 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16843 changed are highlighted.
16844
16845 @end table
16846
16847 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16848 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16849 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16850 indicates the breakpoint type:
16851
16852 @table @code
16853 @item B
16854 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16855
16856 @item b
16857 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16858
16859 @item H
16860 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16861
16862 @item h
16863 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16864
16865 @end table
16866
16867 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16868
16869 @table @code
16870 @item +
16871 Breakpoint is enabled.
16872
16873 @item -
16874 Breakpoint is disabled.
16875
16876 @end table
16877
16878 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16879 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16880 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16881 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16882 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16883 The following layouts are available:
16884
16885 @itemize @bullet
16886 @item
16887 source
16888
16889 @item
16890 assembly
16891
16892 @item
16893 source and assembly
16894
16895 @item
16896 source and registers
16897
16898 @item
16899 assembly and registers
16900
16901 @end itemize
16902
16903 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16904 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16905 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16906 are displayed:
16907
16908 @table @emph
16909 @item target
16910 Indicates the current gdb target
16911 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16912
16913 @item process
16914 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16915 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16916
16917 @item function
16918 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16919 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16920 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16921 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16922
16923 @item line
16924 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16925 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16926
16927 @item pc
16928 Indicates the current program counter address.
16929
16930 @end table
16931
16932 @node TUI Keys
16933 @section TUI Key Bindings
16934 @cindex TUI key bindings
16935
16936 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16937 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16938 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16939 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16940 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16941 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16942 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16943
16944 @table @kbd
16945 @kindex C-x C-a
16946 @item C-x C-a
16947 @kindex C-x a
16948 @itemx C-x a
16949 @kindex C-x A
16950 @itemx C-x A
16951 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16952 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16953 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16954 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16955 The screen is then refreshed.
16956
16957 @kindex C-x 1
16958 @item C-x 1
16959 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16960 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16961 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16962
16963 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16964
16965 @kindex C-x 2
16966 @item C-x 2
16967 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16968 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16969 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16970 previous layout and the new one.
16971
16972 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16973
16974 @kindex C-x o
16975 @item C-x o
16976 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16977 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16978 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16979
16980 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16981
16982 @kindex C-x s
16983 @item C-x s
16984 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16985 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16986
16987 @end table
16988
16989 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16990
16991 @table @key
16992 @kindex PgUp
16993 @item PgUp
16994 Scroll the active window one page up.
16995
16996 @kindex PgDn
16997 @item PgDn
16998 Scroll the active window one page down.
16999
17000 @kindex Up
17001 @item Up
17002 Scroll the active window one line up.
17003
17004 @kindex Down
17005 @item Down
17006 Scroll the active window one line down.
17007
17008 @kindex Left
17009 @item Left
17010 Scroll the active window one column left.
17011
17012 @kindex Right
17013 @item Right
17014 Scroll the active window one column right.
17015
17016 @kindex C-L
17017 @item C-L
17018 Refresh the screen.
17019
17020 @end table
17021
17022 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
17023 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
17024 active window is the command window. When the command window
17025 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
17026 key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} and @kbd{C-f}.
17027
17028 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17029 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17030 @cindex TUI single key mode
17031
17032 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
17033 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
17034 some gdb commands.
17035
17036 @table @kbd
17037 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17038 @item c
17039 continue
17040
17041 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17042 @item d
17043 down
17044
17045 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17046 @item f
17047 finish
17048
17049 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17050 @item n
17051 next
17052
17053 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17054 @item q
17055 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
17056
17057 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17058 @item r
17059 run
17060
17061 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17062 @item s
17063 step
17064
17065 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17066 @item u
17067 up
17068
17069 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17070 @item v
17071 info locals
17072
17073 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17074 @item w
17075 where
17076
17077 @end table
17078
17079 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17080 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17081 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17082 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17083 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17084 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17085
17086
17087 @node TUI Commands
17088 @section TUI specific commands
17089 @cindex TUI commands
17090
17091 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17092 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
17093 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
17094 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
17095 in the TUI mode.
17096
17097 @table @code
17098 @item info win
17099 @kindex info win
17100 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17101
17102 @item layout next
17103 @kindex layout
17104 Display the next layout.
17105
17106 @item layout prev
17107 Display the previous layout.
17108
17109 @item layout src
17110 Display the source window only.
17111
17112 @item layout asm
17113 Display the assembly window only.
17114
17115 @item layout split
17116 Display the source and assembly window.
17117
17118 @item layout regs
17119 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17120
17121 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
17122 @kindex focus
17123 Set the focus to the named window.
17124 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
17125 can be affected to another window.
17126
17127 @item refresh
17128 @kindex refresh
17129 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17130
17131 @item tui reg float
17132 @kindex tui reg
17133 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17134
17135 @item tui reg general
17136 Show the general registers in the register window.
17137
17138 @item tui reg next
17139 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17140 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17141 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17142 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17143
17144 @item tui reg system
17145 Show the system registers in the register window.
17146
17147 @item update
17148 @kindex update
17149 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17150
17151 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17152 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17153 @kindex winheight
17154 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17155 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17156 decrease it.
17157
17158 @item tabset
17159 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
17160 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17161
17162 @end table
17163
17164 @node TUI Configuration
17165 @section TUI configuration variables
17166 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17167
17168 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
17169 appearance of windows on the terminal.
17170
17171 @table @code
17172 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17173 @kindex set tui border-kind
17174 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17175 The possible values are the following:
17176 @table @code
17177 @item space
17178 Use a space character to draw the border.
17179
17180 @item ascii
17181 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
17182
17183 @item acs
17184 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17185 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17186
17187 @end table
17188
17189 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17190 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17191 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
17192 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
17193 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
17194
17195 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17196 @kindex set tui border-mode
17197 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
17198 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17199 @table @code
17200 @item normal
17201 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17202
17203 @item standout
17204 Use standout mode.
17205
17206 @item reverse
17207 Use reverse video mode.
17208
17209 @item half
17210 Use half bright mode.
17211
17212 @item half-standout
17213 Use half bright and standout mode.
17214
17215 @item bold
17216 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17217
17218 @item bold-standout
17219 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17220
17221 @end table
17222
17223 @end table
17224
17225 @node Emacs
17226 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17227
17228 @cindex Emacs
17229 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17230 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17231 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17232 @value{GDBN}.
17233
17234 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17235 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17236 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17237 created Emacs buffer.
17238 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17239
17240 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17241 things:
17242
17243 @itemize @bullet
17244 @item
17245 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
17246 @end itemize
17247
17248 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17249 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17250
17251 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17252 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17253 in this way.
17254
17255 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17256 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17257 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17258 stop.
17259
17260 @itemize @bullet
17261 @item
17262 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17263 @end itemize
17264
17265 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17266 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17267 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17268 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17269 and the source.
17270
17271 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17272 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17273
17274 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17275 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17276 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17277 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17278 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17279 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17280 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17281 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17282 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17283
17284 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17285 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
17286 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
17287 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
17288
17289 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17290 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17291 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17292 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17293 one you want.
17294
17295 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17296 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17297
17298 @table @kbd
17299 @item C-h m
17300 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
17301
17302 @item C-c C-s
17303 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17304 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17305
17306 @item C-c C-n
17307 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17308 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17309 to show the current file and location.
17310
17311 @item C-c C-i
17312 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17313 display window accordingly.
17314
17315 @item C-c C-f
17316 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17317 @code{finish} command.
17318
17319 @item C-c C-r
17320 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17321 command.
17322
17323 @item C-c <
17324 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17325 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17326 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17327
17328 @item C-c >
17329 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17330 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17331 @end table
17332
17333 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17334 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17335
17336 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
17337 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
17338 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
17339 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
17340 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
17341 current one.
17342
17343 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17344 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17345 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17346 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17347 frame.
17348
17349 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17350 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17351 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17352 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17353 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17354 to correspond properly with the code.
17355
17356 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
17357 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
17358 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
17359
17360 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17361 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17362 @ignore
17363 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17364 @kindex Epoch
17365 @kindex inspect
17366
17367 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17368 called the @code{epoch}
17369 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17370 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17371 each value is printed in its own window.
17372 @end ignore
17373
17374
17375 @node GDB/MI
17376 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17377
17378 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17379
17380 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17381 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17382 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17383 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17384 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17385 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17386
17387 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17388 in the form of a reference manual.
17389
17390 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17391 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17392 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17393
17394 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17395
17396 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17397 This chapter uses the following notation:
17398
17399 @itemize @bullet
17400 @item
17401 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17402
17403 @item
17404 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17405 it may or may not be given.
17406
17407 @item
17408 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17409 may repeat zero or more times.
17410
17411 @item
17412 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17413 may repeat one or more times.
17414
17415 @item
17416 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17417 @end itemize
17418
17419 @ignore
17420 @heading Dependencies
17421 @end ignore
17422
17423 @menu
17424 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17425 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17426 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17427 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17428 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17429 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17430 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17431 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17432 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17433 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17434 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17435 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17436 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17437 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17438 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17439 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17440 @ignore
17441 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17442 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17443 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17444 @end ignore
17445 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17446 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17447 @end menu
17448
17449 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17450 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17451 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17452
17453 @menu
17454 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17455 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17456 @end menu
17457
17458 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17459 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17460
17461 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17462 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17463 @table @code
17464 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17465 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17466
17467 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17468 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17469 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17470
17471 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17472 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17473 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17474
17475 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17476 "any sequence of digits"
17477
17478 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17479 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17480
17481 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17482 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17483
17484 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17485 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17486
17487 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17488 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17489 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17490
17491 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17492 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17493
17494 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17495 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17496 @end table
17497
17498 @noindent
17499 Notes:
17500
17501 @itemize @bullet
17502 @item
17503 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17504 output is described below.
17505
17506 @item
17507 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17508 finishes.
17509
17510 @item
17511 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17512 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17513 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17514 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17515 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17516 @end itemize
17517
17518 Pragmatics:
17519
17520 @itemize @bullet
17521 @item
17522 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17523
17524 @item
17525 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17526 @end itemize
17527
17528 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17529 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17530
17531 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17532 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17533 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17534 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17535 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17536 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17537
17538 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17539 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17540 @var{token}.
17541
17542 @table @code
17543 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17544 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17545
17546 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17547 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17548
17549 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17550 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17551
17552 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17553 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17554
17555 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17556 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17557
17558 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17559 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17560
17561 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17562 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17563
17564 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17565 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17566
17567 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17568 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17569
17570 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17571 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17572 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17573
17574 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17575 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17576
17577 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17578 @code{ @var{string} }
17579
17580 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17581 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17582
17583 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17584 @code{@var{c-string}}
17585
17586 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17587 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17588
17589 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17590 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17591 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17592
17593 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17594 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17595
17596 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17597 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17598
17599 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17600 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17601
17602 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17603 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17604
17605 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17606 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17607
17608 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17609 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17610 @end table
17611
17612 @noindent
17613 Notes:
17614
17615 @itemize @bullet
17616 @item
17617 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17618
17619 @item
17620 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17621 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17622 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17623 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17624
17625 @item
17626 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17627 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17628 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17629 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17630
17631 @item
17632 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17633 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17634 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17635 @samp{*}.
17636
17637 @item
17638 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17639 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17640 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17641 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17642
17643 @item
17644 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17645 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17646 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17647 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17648
17649 @item
17650 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17651 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17652 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17653
17654 @item
17655 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17656 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17657 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17658 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17659
17660 @item
17661 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17662 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17663 @var{values}.
17664
17665
17666 @end itemize
17667
17668 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17669 details about the various output records.
17670
17671 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17672 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17673 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17674
17675 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17676 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17677
17678 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17679 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17680 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17681 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17682 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17683 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17684
17685 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17686 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17687 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17688
17689 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17690 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17691 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17692 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17693
17694 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17695 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17696
17697 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17698 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17699 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17700 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17701 might change.
17702
17703 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17704 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17705 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17706 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17707
17708 @itemize @bullet
17709 @item
17710 New MI commands may be added.
17711
17712 @item
17713 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17714
17715 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17716 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17717
17718 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17719 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17720 @end itemize
17721
17722 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17723 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17724 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17725 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17726 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17727
17728 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17729 @c version?
17730
17731 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17732 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17733 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17734 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17735 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17736 Group, which has the aim of creating a a more general MI protocol
17737 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17738 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17739 @cindex mailing lists
17740
17741 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17742 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17743 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17744
17745 @menu
17746 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17747 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17748 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17749 @end menu
17750
17751 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17752 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17753
17754 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17755 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17756 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17757 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17758
17759 @table @code
17760 @findex ^done
17761 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17762 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17763 values.
17764
17765 @item "^running"
17766 @findex ^running
17767 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17768 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17769 running.
17770
17771 @item "^connected"
17772 @findex ^connected
17773 GDB has connected to a remote target.
17774
17775 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17776 @findex ^error
17777 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17778 error message.
17779
17780 @item "^exit"
17781 @findex ^exit
17782 GDB has terminated.
17783
17784 @end table
17785
17786 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17787 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17788
17789 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17790 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17791 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17792 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17793 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17794
17795 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17796 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17797 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17798 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17799 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17800
17801 @table @code
17802 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17803 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17804 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17805
17806 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17807 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17808 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17809 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17810
17811 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17812 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17813 internals.
17814 @end table
17815
17816 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17817 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17818
17819 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17820 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17821 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17822 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17823 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17824 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17825
17826 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17827 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17828
17829 @table @code
17830 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17831 @end table
17832
17833 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17834
17835 @table @code
17836 @item breakpoint-hit
17837 A breakpoint was reached.
17838 @item watchpoint-trigger
17839 A watchpoint was triggered.
17840 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17841 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17842 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17843 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17844 @item function-finished
17845 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17846 @item location-reached
17847 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17848 @item watchpoint-scope
17849 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17850 @item end-stepping-range
17851 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17852 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17853 @item exited-signalled
17854 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17855 @item exited
17856 The inferior exited.
17857 @item exited-normally
17858 The inferior exited normally.
17859 @item signal-received
17860 A signal was received by the inferior.
17861 @end table
17862
17863
17864 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17865 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17866 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17867 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17868
17869 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17870 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17871 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17872 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17873
17874 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17875 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17876
17877 @subheading Setting a breakpoint
17878
17879 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17880 information of the breakpoint.
17881
17882 @smallexample
17883 -> -break-insert main
17884 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17885 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17886 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17887 <- (gdb)
17888 @end smallexample
17889
17890 @subheading Program Execution
17891
17892 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17893 reason that execution stopped.
17894
17895 @smallexample
17896 -> -exec-run
17897 <- ^running
17898 <- (gdb)
17899 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17900 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17901 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17902 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17903 <- (gdb)
17904 -> -exec-continue
17905 <- ^running
17906 <- (gdb)
17907 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17908 <- (gdb)
17909 @end smallexample
17910
17911 @subheading Quitting GDB
17912
17913 Quitting GDB just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17914
17915 @smallexample
17916 -> (gdb)
17917 <- -gdb-exit
17918 <- ^exit
17919 @end smallexample
17920
17921 @subheading A Bad Command
17922
17923 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17924
17925 @smallexample
17926 -> -rubbish
17927 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17928 <- (gdb)
17929 @end smallexample
17930
17931
17932 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17933 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17934 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17935
17936 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17937 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17938
17939 @subheading Motivation
17940
17941 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17942
17943 @subheading Introduction
17944
17945 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17946
17947 @subheading Commands
17948
17949 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17950
17951 @subsubheading Synopsis
17952
17953 @smallexample
17954 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17955 @end smallexample
17956
17957 @subsubheading Result
17958
17959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17960
17961 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17962
17963 @subsubheading Example
17964
17965 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17966 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17967
17968
17969 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17970 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17971 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17972
17973 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17974 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17975 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17976 breakpoints.
17977
17978 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17979 @findex -break-after
17980
17981 @subsubheading Synopsis
17982
17983 @smallexample
17984 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17985 @end smallexample
17986
17987 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17988 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17989 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17990 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17991
17992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17993
17994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17995
17996 @subsubheading Example
17997
17998 @smallexample
17999 (gdb)
18000 -break-insert main
18001 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
18002 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18003 (gdb)
18004 -break-after 1 3
18005 ~
18006 ^done
18007 (gdb)
18008 -break-list
18009 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18010 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18011 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18012 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18013 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18014 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18015 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18016 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18017 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18018 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18019 (gdb)
18020 @end smallexample
18021
18022 @ignore
18023 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18024 @findex -break-catch
18025
18026 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18027 @findex -break-commands
18028 @end ignore
18029
18030
18031 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18032 @findex -break-condition
18033
18034 @subsubheading Synopsis
18035
18036 @smallexample
18037 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18038 @end smallexample
18039
18040 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18041 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18042 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18043 command below).
18044
18045 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18046
18047 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18048
18049 @subsubheading Example
18050
18051 @smallexample
18052 (gdb)
18053 -break-condition 1 1
18054 ^done
18055 (gdb)
18056 -break-list
18057 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18058 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18059 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18060 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18061 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18062 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18063 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18064 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18065 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18066 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18067 (gdb)
18068 @end smallexample
18069
18070 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18071 @findex -break-delete
18072
18073 @subsubheading Synopsis
18074
18075 @smallexample
18076 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18077 @end smallexample
18078
18079 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18080 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18081
18082 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18083
18084 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18085
18086 @subsubheading Example
18087
18088 @smallexample
18089 (gdb)
18090 -break-delete 1
18091 ^done
18092 (gdb)
18093 -break-list
18094 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18095 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18096 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18097 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18098 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18099 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18100 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18101 body=[]@}
18102 (gdb)
18103 @end smallexample
18104
18105 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18106 @findex -break-disable
18107
18108 @subsubheading Synopsis
18109
18110 @smallexample
18111 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18112 @end smallexample
18113
18114 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18115 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18116
18117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18118
18119 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18120
18121 @subsubheading Example
18122
18123 @smallexample
18124 (gdb)
18125 -break-disable 2
18126 ^done
18127 (gdb)
18128 -break-list
18129 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18130 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18131 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18132 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18133 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18134 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18135 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18136 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18137 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18138 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18139 (gdb)
18140 @end smallexample
18141
18142 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18143 @findex -break-enable
18144
18145 @subsubheading Synopsis
18146
18147 @smallexample
18148 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18149 @end smallexample
18150
18151 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18152
18153 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18154
18155 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18156
18157 @subsubheading Example
18158
18159 @smallexample
18160 (gdb)
18161 -break-enable 2
18162 ^done
18163 (gdb)
18164 -break-list
18165 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18166 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18167 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18168 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18169 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18170 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18171 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18172 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18173 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18174 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18175 (gdb)
18176 @end smallexample
18177
18178 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18179 @findex -break-info
18180
18181 @subsubheading Synopsis
18182
18183 @smallexample
18184 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18185 @end smallexample
18186
18187 @c REDUNDANT???
18188 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18189
18190 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18191
18192 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18193
18194 @subsubheading Example
18195 N.A.
18196
18197 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18198 @findex -break-insert
18199
18200 @subsubheading Synopsis
18201
18202 @smallexample
18203 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
18204 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18205 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
18206 @end smallexample
18207
18208 @noindent
18209 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
18210
18211 @itemize @bullet
18212 @item function
18213 @c @item +offset
18214 @c @item -offset
18215 @c @item linenum
18216 @item filename:linenum
18217 @item filename:function
18218 @item *address
18219 @end itemize
18220
18221 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18222
18223 @table @samp
18224 @item -t
18225 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18226 @item -h
18227 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18228 @item -c @var{condition}
18229 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18230 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18231 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18232 @item -r
18233 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
18234 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
18235 expresson.
18236 @end table
18237
18238 @subsubheading Result
18239
18240 The result is in the form:
18241
18242 @smallexample
18243 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18244 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18245 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18246 times="@var{times}"@}
18247 @end smallexample
18248
18249 @noindent
18250 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18251 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18252 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18253 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18254 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18255 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18256 which use the same output).
18257
18258 Note: this format is open to change.
18259 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18260
18261 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18262
18263 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18264 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18265
18266 @subsubheading Example
18267
18268 @smallexample
18269 (gdb)
18270 -break-insert main
18271 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18272 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18273 (gdb)
18274 -break-insert -t foo
18275 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18276 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18277 (gdb)
18278 -break-list
18279 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18280 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18281 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18282 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18283 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18284 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18285 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18286 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18287 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18288 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18289 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18290 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18291 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18292 (gdb)
18293 -break-insert -r foo.*
18294 ~int foo(int, int);
18295 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18296 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18297 (gdb)
18298 @end smallexample
18299
18300 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18301 @findex -break-list
18302
18303 @subsubheading Synopsis
18304
18305 @smallexample
18306 -break-list
18307 @end smallexample
18308
18309 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18310
18311 @table @samp
18312 @item Number
18313 number of the breakpoint
18314 @item Type
18315 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18316 @item Disposition
18317 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18318 or @samp{nokeep}
18319 @item Enabled
18320 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18321 @item Address
18322 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18323 @item What
18324 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18325 name, line number
18326 @item Times
18327 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18328 @end table
18329
18330 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18331 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18332
18333 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18334
18335 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18336
18337 @subsubheading Example
18338
18339 @smallexample
18340 (gdb)
18341 -break-list
18342 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18343 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18344 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18345 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18346 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18347 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18348 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18349 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18350 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18351 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18352 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18353 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18354 (gdb)
18355 @end smallexample
18356
18357 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18358
18359 @smallexample
18360 (gdb)
18361 -break-list
18362 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18363 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18364 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18365 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18366 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18367 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18368 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18369 body=[]@}
18370 (gdb)
18371 @end smallexample
18372
18373 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18374 @findex -break-watch
18375
18376 @subsubheading Synopsis
18377
18378 @smallexample
18379 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18380 @end smallexample
18381
18382 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18383 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18384 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18385 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
18386 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18387 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18388 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18389 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
18390
18391 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18392 breakpoints inserted.
18393
18394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18395
18396 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18397 @samp{rwatch}.
18398
18399 @subsubheading Example
18400
18401 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18402
18403 @smallexample
18404 (gdb)
18405 -break-watch x
18406 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18407 (gdb)
18408 -exec-continue
18409 ^running
18410 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18411 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18412 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18413 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18414 (gdb)
18415 @end smallexample
18416
18417 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18418 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18419 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18420
18421 @smallexample
18422 (gdb)
18423 -break-watch C
18424 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18425 (gdb)
18426 -exec-continue
18427 ^running
18428 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18429 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18430 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18431 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18432 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18433 (gdb)
18434 -exec-continue
18435 ^running
18436 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18437 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18438 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18439 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18440 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18441 (gdb)
18442 @end smallexample
18443
18444 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18445 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18446 deleted.
18447
18448 @smallexample
18449 (gdb)
18450 -break-watch C
18451 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18452 (gdb)
18453 -break-list
18454 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18455 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18456 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18457 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18458 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18459 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18460 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18461 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18462 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18463 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18464 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18465 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18466 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18467 (gdb)
18468 -exec-continue
18469 ^running
18470 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18471 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18472 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18473 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18474 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18475 (gdb)
18476 -break-list
18477 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18478 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18479 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18480 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18481 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18482 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18483 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18484 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18485 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18486 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18487 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18488 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18489 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18490 (gdb)
18491 -exec-continue
18492 ^running
18493 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18494 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18495 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18496 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18497 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18498 (gdb)
18499 -break-list
18500 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18501 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18502 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18503 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18504 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18505 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18506 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18507 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18508 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18509 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18510 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18511 times="1"@}]@}
18512 (gdb)
18513 @end smallexample
18514
18515 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18516 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18517 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18518
18519 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18520 @findex -exec-arguments
18521
18522
18523 @subsubheading Synopsis
18524
18525 @smallexample
18526 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18527 @end smallexample
18528
18529 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18530 @samp{-exec-run}.
18531
18532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18533
18534 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18535
18536 @subsubheading Example
18537
18538 @c FIXME!
18539 Don't have one around.
18540
18541
18542 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18543 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18544
18545 @subsubheading Synopsis
18546
18547 @smallexample
18548 -exec-show-arguments
18549 @end smallexample
18550
18551 Print the arguments of the program.
18552
18553 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18554
18555 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18556
18557 @subsubheading Example
18558 N.A.
18559
18560
18561 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18562 @findex -environment-cd
18563
18564 @subsubheading Synopsis
18565
18566 @smallexample
18567 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18568 @end smallexample
18569
18570 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18571
18572 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18573
18574 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18575
18576 @subsubheading Example
18577
18578 @smallexample
18579 (gdb)
18580 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18581 ^done
18582 (gdb)
18583 @end smallexample
18584
18585
18586 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18587 @findex -environment-directory
18588
18589 @subsubheading Synopsis
18590
18591 @smallexample
18592 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18593 @end smallexample
18594
18595 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18596 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18597 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18598 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18599 occurs as normal.
18600 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18601 multiple directories in a single command
18602 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18603 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18604 If blanks are needed as
18605 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18606 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18607 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18608 character must not be used
18609 in any directory name.
18610 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18611
18612 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18613
18614 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18615
18616 @subsubheading Example
18617
18618 @smallexample
18619 (gdb)
18620 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18621 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18622 (gdb)
18623 -environment-directory ""
18624 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18625 (gdb)
18626 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18627 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18628 (gdb)
18629 -environment-directory -r
18630 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18631 (gdb)
18632 @end smallexample
18633
18634
18635 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18636 @findex -environment-path
18637
18638 @subsubheading Synopsis
18639
18640 @smallexample
18641 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18642 @end smallexample
18643
18644 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18645 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18646 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18647 supplied in addition to the
18648 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18649 occurs as normal.
18650 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18651 multiple directories in a single command
18652 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18653 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18654 If blanks are needed as
18655 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18656 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18657 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18658 character must not be used
18659 in any directory name.
18660 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18661
18662
18663 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18664
18665 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18666
18667 @subsubheading Example
18668
18669 @smallexample
18670 (gdb)
18671 -environment-path
18672 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18673 (gdb)
18674 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18675 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18676 (gdb)
18677 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18678 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18679 (gdb)
18680 @end smallexample
18681
18682
18683 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18684 @findex -environment-pwd
18685
18686 @subsubheading Synopsis
18687
18688 @smallexample
18689 -environment-pwd
18690 @end smallexample
18691
18692 Show the current working directory.
18693
18694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18695
18696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18697
18698 @subsubheading Example
18699
18700 @smallexample
18701 (gdb)
18702 -environment-pwd
18703 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18704 (gdb)
18705 @end smallexample
18706
18707 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18708 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18709 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18710
18711
18712 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18713 @findex -thread-info
18714
18715 @subsubheading Synopsis
18716
18717 @smallexample
18718 -thread-info
18719 @end smallexample
18720
18721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18722
18723 No equivalent.
18724
18725 @subsubheading Example
18726 N.A.
18727
18728
18729 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18730 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18731
18732 @subsubheading Synopsis
18733
18734 @smallexample
18735 -thread-list-all-threads
18736 @end smallexample
18737
18738 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18739
18740 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18741
18742 @subsubheading Example
18743 N.A.
18744
18745
18746 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18747 @findex -thread-list-ids
18748
18749 @subsubheading Synopsis
18750
18751 @smallexample
18752 -thread-list-ids
18753 @end smallexample
18754
18755 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18756 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18757
18758 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18759
18760 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18761
18762 @subsubheading Example
18763
18764 No threads present, besides the main process:
18765
18766 @smallexample
18767 (gdb)
18768 -thread-list-ids
18769 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18770 (gdb)
18771 @end smallexample
18772
18773
18774 Several threads:
18775
18776 @smallexample
18777 (gdb)
18778 -thread-list-ids
18779 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18780 number-of-threads="3"
18781 (gdb)
18782 @end smallexample
18783
18784
18785 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18786 @findex -thread-select
18787
18788 @subsubheading Synopsis
18789
18790 @smallexample
18791 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18792 @end smallexample
18793
18794 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18795 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18796
18797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18798
18799 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18800
18801 @subsubheading Example
18802
18803 @smallexample
18804 (gdb)
18805 -exec-next
18806 ^running
18807 (gdb)
18808 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18809 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18810 (gdb)
18811 -thread-list-ids
18812 ^done,
18813 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18814 number-of-threads="3"
18815 (gdb)
18816 -thread-select 3
18817 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18818 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18819 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18820 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18821 (gdb)
18822 @end smallexample
18823
18824 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18825 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18826 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18827
18828 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18829 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently GDB only really executes
18830 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18831 other cases.
18832
18833 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18834 @findex -exec-continue
18835
18836 @subsubheading Synopsis
18837
18838 @smallexample
18839 -exec-continue
18840 @end smallexample
18841
18842 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18843 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18844
18845 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18846
18847 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18848
18849 @subsubheading Example
18850
18851 @smallexample
18852 -exec-continue
18853 ^running
18854 (gdb)
18855 @@Hello world
18856 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18857 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18858 (gdb)
18859 @end smallexample
18860
18861
18862 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18863 @findex -exec-finish
18864
18865 @subsubheading Synopsis
18866
18867 @smallexample
18868 -exec-finish
18869 @end smallexample
18870
18871 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18872 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18873
18874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18875
18876 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18877
18878 @subsubheading Example
18879
18880 Function returning @code{void}.
18881
18882 @smallexample
18883 -exec-finish
18884 ^running
18885 (gdb)
18886 @@hello from foo
18887 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18888 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18889 (gdb)
18890 @end smallexample
18891
18892 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18893 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18894 value itself.
18895
18896 @smallexample
18897 -exec-finish
18898 ^running
18899 (gdb)
18900 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18901 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18902 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18903 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18904 (gdb)
18905 @end smallexample
18906
18907
18908 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18909 @findex -exec-interrupt
18910
18911 @subsubheading Synopsis
18912
18913 @smallexample
18914 -exec-interrupt
18915 @end smallexample
18916
18917 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18918 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18919 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18920 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18921 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18922
18923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18924
18925 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18926
18927 @subsubheading Example
18928
18929 @smallexample
18930 (gdb)
18931 111-exec-continue
18932 111^running
18933
18934 (gdb)
18935 222-exec-interrupt
18936 222^done
18937 (gdb)
18938 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18939 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18940 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18941 (gdb)
18942
18943 (gdb)
18944 -exec-interrupt
18945 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18946 (gdb)
18947 @end smallexample
18948
18949
18950 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18951 @findex -exec-next
18952
18953 @subsubheading Synopsis
18954
18955 @smallexample
18956 -exec-next
18957 @end smallexample
18958
18959 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18960 of the next source line is reached.
18961
18962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18963
18964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18965
18966 @subsubheading Example
18967
18968 @smallexample
18969 -exec-next
18970 ^running
18971 (gdb)
18972 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18973 (gdb)
18974 @end smallexample
18975
18976
18977 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18978 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18979
18980 @subsubheading Synopsis
18981
18982 @smallexample
18983 -exec-next-instruction
18984 @end smallexample
18985
18986 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18987 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18988 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18989 printed as well.
18990
18991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18992
18993 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18994
18995 @subsubheading Example
18996
18997 @smallexample
18998 (gdb)
18999 -exec-next-instruction
19000 ^running
19001
19002 (gdb)
19003 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19004 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19005 (gdb)
19006 @end smallexample
19007
19008
19009 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19010 @findex -exec-return
19011
19012 @subsubheading Synopsis
19013
19014 @smallexample
19015 -exec-return
19016 @end smallexample
19017
19018 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19019 Displays the new current frame.
19020
19021 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19022
19023 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19024
19025 @subsubheading Example
19026
19027 @smallexample
19028 (gdb)
19029 200-break-insert callee4
19030 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19031 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19032 (gdb)
19033 000-exec-run
19034 000^running
19035 (gdb)
19036 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19037 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19038 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19039 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19040 (gdb)
19041 205-break-delete
19042 205^done
19043 (gdb)
19044 111-exec-return
19045 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19046 args=[@{name="strarg",
19047 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19048 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19049 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19050 (gdb)
19051 @end smallexample
19052
19053
19054 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19055 @findex -exec-run
19056
19057 @subsubheading Synopsis
19058
19059 @smallexample
19060 -exec-run
19061 @end smallexample
19062
19063 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19064 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19065 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19066 the program has exited exceptionally.
19067
19068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19069
19070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19071
19072 @subsubheading Examples
19073
19074 @smallexample
19075 (gdb)
19076 -break-insert main
19077 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19078 (gdb)
19079 -exec-run
19080 ^running
19081 (gdb)
19082 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19083 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19084 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19085 (gdb)
19086 @end smallexample
19087
19088 @noindent
19089 Program exited normally:
19090
19091 @smallexample
19092 (gdb)
19093 -exec-run
19094 ^running
19095 (gdb)
19096 x = 55
19097 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19098 (gdb)
19099 @end smallexample
19100
19101 @noindent
19102 Program exited exceptionally:
19103
19104 @smallexample
19105 (gdb)
19106 -exec-run
19107 ^running
19108 (gdb)
19109 x = 55
19110 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19111 (gdb)
19112 @end smallexample
19113
19114 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19115 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19116
19117 @smallexample
19118 (gdb)
19119 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19120 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19121 @end smallexample
19122
19123
19124 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19125
19126
19127 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19128 @findex -exec-step
19129
19130 @subsubheading Synopsis
19131
19132 @smallexample
19133 -exec-step
19134 @end smallexample
19135
19136 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19137 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19138 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19139 function.
19140
19141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19142
19143 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19144
19145 @subsubheading Example
19146
19147 Stepping into a function:
19148
19149 @smallexample
19150 -exec-step
19151 ^running
19152 (gdb)
19153 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19154 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19155 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19156 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19157 (gdb)
19158 @end smallexample
19159
19160 Regular stepping:
19161
19162 @smallexample
19163 -exec-step
19164 ^running
19165 (gdb)
19166 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19167 (gdb)
19168 @end smallexample
19169
19170
19171 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19172 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19173
19174 @subsubheading Synopsis
19175
19176 @smallexample
19177 -exec-step-instruction
19178 @end smallexample
19179
19180 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19181 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19182 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19183 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19184 well.
19185
19186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19187
19188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19189
19190 @subsubheading Example
19191
19192 @smallexample
19193 (gdb)
19194 -exec-step-instruction
19195 ^running
19196
19197 (gdb)
19198 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19199 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19200 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19201 (gdb)
19202 -exec-step-instruction
19203 ^running
19204
19205 (gdb)
19206 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19207 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19208 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19209 (gdb)
19210 @end smallexample
19211
19212
19213 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19214 @findex -exec-until
19215
19216 @subsubheading Synopsis
19217
19218 @smallexample
19219 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19220 @end smallexample
19221
19222 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19223 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19224 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19225 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19226
19227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19228
19229 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19230
19231 @subsubheading Example
19232
19233 @smallexample
19234 (gdb)
19235 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19236 ^running
19237 (gdb)
19238 x = 55
19239 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19240 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19241 (gdb)
19242 @end smallexample
19243
19244 @ignore
19245 @subheading -file-clear
19246 Is this going away????
19247 @end ignore
19248
19249 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19250 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19251 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19252
19253
19254 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19255 @findex -stack-info-frame
19256
19257 @subsubheading Synopsis
19258
19259 @smallexample
19260 -stack-info-frame
19261 @end smallexample
19262
19263 Get info on the selected frame.
19264
19265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19266
19267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19268 (without arguments).
19269
19270 @subsubheading Example
19271
19272 @smallexample
19273 (gdb)
19274 -stack-info-frame
19275 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19276 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19277 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19278 (gdb)
19279 @end smallexample
19280
19281 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19282 @findex -stack-info-depth
19283
19284 @subsubheading Synopsis
19285
19286 @smallexample
19287 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19288 @end smallexample
19289
19290 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19291 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19292
19293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19294
19295 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19296
19297 @subsubheading Example
19298
19299 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19300
19301 @smallexample
19302 (gdb)
19303 -stack-info-depth
19304 ^done,depth="12"
19305 (gdb)
19306 -stack-info-depth 4
19307 ^done,depth="4"
19308 (gdb)
19309 -stack-info-depth 12
19310 ^done,depth="12"
19311 (gdb)
19312 -stack-info-depth 11
19313 ^done,depth="11"
19314 (gdb)
19315 -stack-info-depth 13
19316 ^done,depth="12"
19317 (gdb)
19318 @end smallexample
19319
19320 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19321 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19322
19323 @subsubheading Synopsis
19324
19325 @smallexample
19326 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19327 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19328 @end smallexample
19329
19330 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19331 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19332 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19333 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19334 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19335 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19336 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19337 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19338
19339 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19340 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19341 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19342
19343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19344
19345 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19346 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19347 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19348
19349 @subsubheading Example
19350
19351 @smallexample
19352 (gdb)
19353 -stack-list-frames
19354 ^done,
19355 stack=[
19356 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19357 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19358 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19359 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19360 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19361 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19362 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19363 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19364 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19365 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19366 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19367 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19368 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19369 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19370 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19371 (gdb)
19372 -stack-list-arguments 0
19373 ^done,
19374 stack-args=[
19375 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19376 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19377 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19378 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19379 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19380 (gdb)
19381 -stack-list-arguments 1
19382 ^done,
19383 stack-args=[
19384 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19385 frame=@{level="1",
19386 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19387 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19388 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19389 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19390 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19391 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19392 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19393 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19394 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19395 (gdb)
19396 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19397 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19398 (gdb)
19399 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19400 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19401 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19402 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19403 (gdb)
19404 @end smallexample
19405
19406 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19407
19408
19409 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19410 @findex -stack-list-frames
19411
19412 @subsubheading Synopsis
19413
19414 @smallexample
19415 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19416 @end smallexample
19417
19418 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19419 following info:
19420
19421 @table @samp
19422 @item @var{level}
19423 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
19424 @item @var{addr}
19425 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19426 @item @var{func}
19427 Function name.
19428 @item @var{file}
19429 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19430 @item @var{line}
19431 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19432 @end table
19433
19434 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19435 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19436 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19437 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19438 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19439 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19440 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19441
19442 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19443
19444 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19445
19446 @subsubheading Example
19447
19448 Full stack backtrace:
19449
19450 @smallexample
19451 (gdb)
19452 -stack-list-frames
19453 ^done,stack=
19454 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19455 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19456 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19457 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19458 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19459 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19460 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19461 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19462 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19463 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19464 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19465 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19466 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19467 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19468 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19469 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19470 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19471 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19472 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19473 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19474 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19475 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19476 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19477 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19478 (gdb)
19479 @end smallexample
19480
19481 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19482
19483 @smallexample
19484 (gdb)
19485 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19486 ^done,stack=
19487 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19488 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19489 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19490 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19491 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19492 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19493 (gdb)
19494 @end smallexample
19495
19496 Show a single frame:
19497
19498 @smallexample
19499 (gdb)
19500 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19501 ^done,stack=
19502 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19503 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19504 (gdb)
19505 @end smallexample
19506
19507
19508 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19509 @findex -stack-list-locals
19510
19511 @subsubheading Synopsis
19512
19513 @smallexample
19514 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19515 @end smallexample
19516
19517 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19518 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19519 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19520 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19521 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19522 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19523 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19524 other data types when the the user wishes to explore their values in
19525 more detail.
19526
19527 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19528
19529 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19530
19531 @subsubheading Example
19532
19533 @smallexample
19534 (gdb)
19535 -stack-list-locals 0
19536 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19537 (gdb)
19538 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19539 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19540 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19541 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19542 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19543 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19544 (gdb)
19545 @end smallexample
19546
19547
19548 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19549 @findex -stack-select-frame
19550
19551 @subsubheading Synopsis
19552
19553 @smallexample
19554 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19555 @end smallexample
19556
19557 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19558 the stack.
19559
19560 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19561
19562 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19563 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19564
19565 @subsubheading Example
19566
19567 @smallexample
19568 (gdb)
19569 -stack-select-frame 2
19570 ^done
19571 (gdb)
19572 @end smallexample
19573
19574 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19575 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19576 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19577
19578 @ignore
19579
19580 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19581
19582 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19583 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19584 used by @code{Insight}.
19585
19586 The two main reasons for that are:
19587
19588 @enumerate 1
19589 @item
19590 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19591
19592 @item
19593 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19594 now).
19595 @end enumerate
19596
19597 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19598 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19599 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19600 hints about their use.
19601
19602 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19603 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19604 least, the following operations:
19605
19606 @itemize @bullet
19607 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19608 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19609 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19610 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19611 @end itemize
19612
19613 @end ignore
19614
19615 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19616
19617 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19618
19619 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19620 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19621 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19622 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19623 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19624 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19625 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19626 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19627 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19628 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19629 object, or to change display format.
19630
19631 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19632 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19633 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19634 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19635 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19636 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types.
19637
19638 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19639 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19640 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19641 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19642 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19643
19644 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19645 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19646 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19647 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19648 be transferred to the frontend.
19649
19650 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19651 access this functionality:
19652
19653 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19654 @item @strong{Operation}
19655 @tab @strong{Description}
19656
19657 @item @code{-var-create}
19658 @tab create a variable object
19659 @item @code{-var-delete}
19660 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19661 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19662 @tab set the display format of this variable
19663 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19664 @tab show the display format of this variable
19665 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19666 @tab tells how many children this object has
19667 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19668 @tab return a list of the object's children
19669 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19670 @tab show the type of this variable object
19671 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19672 @tab print what this variable object represents
19673 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19674 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19675 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19676 @tab get the value of this variable
19677 @item @code{-var-assign}
19678 @tab set the value of this variable
19679 @item @code{-var-update}
19680 @tab update the variable and its children
19681 @end multitable
19682
19683 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19684 how it can be used.
19685
19686 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19687
19688 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19689 @findex -var-create
19690
19691 @subsubheading Synopsis
19692
19693 @smallexample
19694 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19695 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19696 @end smallexample
19697
19698 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19699 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19700 register.
19701
19702 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19703 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19704 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19705 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19706 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19707
19708 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19709 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19710 frame should be used.
19711
19712 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19713 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19714
19715 @itemize @bullet
19716 @item
19717 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19718
19719 @item
19720 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19721
19722 @item
19723 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19724 @end itemize
19725
19726 @subsubheading Result
19727
19728 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19729 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19730 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19731
19732 @smallexample
19733 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19734 @end smallexample
19735
19736
19737 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19738 @findex -var-delete
19739
19740 @subsubheading Synopsis
19741
19742 @smallexample
19743 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19744 @end smallexample
19745
19746 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19747 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19748
19749 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19750
19751
19752 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19753 @findex -var-set-format
19754
19755 @subsubheading Synopsis
19756
19757 @smallexample
19758 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19759 @end smallexample
19760
19761 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19762 @var{format-spec}.
19763
19764 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19765
19766 @smallexample
19767 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19768 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19769 @end smallexample
19770
19771 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19772 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19773 for pointers, etc.).
19774
19775 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19776 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19777
19778 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19779 @findex -var-show-format
19780
19781 @subsubheading Synopsis
19782
19783 @smallexample
19784 -var-show-format @var{name}
19785 @end smallexample
19786
19787 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19788
19789 @smallexample
19790 @var{format} @expansion{}
19791 @var{format-spec}
19792 @end smallexample
19793
19794
19795 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19796 @findex -var-info-num-children
19797
19798 @subsubheading Synopsis
19799
19800 @smallexample
19801 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19802 @end smallexample
19803
19804 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19805
19806 @smallexample
19807 numchild=@var{n}
19808 @end smallexample
19809
19810
19811 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19812 @findex -var-list-children
19813
19814 @subsubheading Synopsis
19815
19816 @smallexample
19817 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19818 @end smallexample
19819 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19820
19821 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19822 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19823 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19824 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19825 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19826 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19827 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19828 and unions.
19829
19830 @subsubheading Example
19831
19832 @smallexample
19833 (gdb)
19834 -var-list-children n
19835 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19836 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19837 (gdb)
19838 -var-list-children --all-values n
19839 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19840 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19841 @end smallexample
19842
19843
19844 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19845 @findex -var-info-type
19846
19847 @subsubheading Synopsis
19848
19849 @smallexample
19850 -var-info-type @var{name}
19851 @end smallexample
19852
19853 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19854 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19855 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19856
19857 @smallexample
19858 type=@var{typename}
19859 @end smallexample
19860
19861
19862 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19863 @findex -var-info-expression
19864
19865 @subsubheading Synopsis
19866
19867 @smallexample
19868 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19869 @end smallexample
19870
19871 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19872
19873 @smallexample
19874 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19875 @end smallexample
19876
19877 @noindent
19878 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19879
19880 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19881 @findex -var-show-attributes
19882
19883 @subsubheading Synopsis
19884
19885 @smallexample
19886 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19887 @end smallexample
19888
19889 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19890
19891 @smallexample
19892 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19893 @end smallexample
19894
19895 @noindent
19896 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19897
19898 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19899 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19900
19901 @subsubheading Synopsis
19902
19903 @smallexample
19904 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19905 @end smallexample
19906
19907 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19908 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
19909 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
19910
19911 @smallexample
19912 value=@var{value}
19913 @end smallexample
19914
19915 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19916 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19917
19918 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19919 @findex -var-assign
19920
19921 @subsubheading Synopsis
19922
19923 @smallexample
19924 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19925 @end smallexample
19926
19927 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19928 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19929 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19930 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19931
19932 @subsubheading Example
19933
19934 @smallexample
19935 (gdb)
19936 -var-assign var1 3
19937 ^done,value="3"
19938 (gdb)
19939 -var-update *
19940 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19941 (gdb)
19942 @end smallexample
19943
19944 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19945 @findex -var-update
19946
19947 @subsubheading Synopsis
19948
19949 @smallexample
19950 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19951 @end smallexample
19952
19953 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
19954 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
19955 list of variable objects whose values have changed. Here,
19956 ``changed'' means that the result of @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before
19957 and after the @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used
19958 as the variable object names, all existing variable objects are
19959 updated. The option @var{print-values} determines whether both names
19960 and values, or just names are printed. The possible values of
19961 this options are the same as for @code{-var-list-children}
19962 (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is recommended to use the
19963 @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the number of MI commands needed
19964 on each program stop.
19965
19966
19967 @subsubheading Example
19968
19969 @smallexample
19970 (gdb)
19971 -var-assign var1 3
19972 ^done,value="3"
19973 (gdb)
19974 -var-update --all-values var1
19975 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19976 type_changed="false"@}]
19977 (gdb)
19978 @end smallexample
19979
19980 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19981 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19982 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19983
19984 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19985 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19986 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19987 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19988
19989 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19990 @c @subheading -data-assign
19991 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19992 @c @subsubheading GDB command
19993 @c set variable
19994 @c @subsubheading Example
19995 @c N.A.
19996
19997 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19998 @findex -data-disassemble
19999
20000 @subsubheading Synopsis
20001
20002 @smallexample
20003 -data-disassemble
20004 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20005 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20006 -- @var{mode}
20007 @end smallexample
20008
20009 @noindent
20010 Where:
20011
20012 @table @samp
20013 @item @var{start-addr}
20014 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20015 @item @var{end-addr}
20016 is the end address
20017 @item @var{filename}
20018 is the name of the file to disassemble
20019 @item @var{linenum}
20020 is the line number to disassemble around
20021 @item @var{lines}
20022 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20023 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20024 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20025 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20026 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20027 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20028 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20029 are displayed.
20030 @item @var{mode}
20031 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20032 disassembly).
20033 @end table
20034
20035 @subsubheading Result
20036
20037 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20038
20039 @itemize @bullet
20040 @item Address
20041 @item Func-name
20042 @item Offset
20043 @item Instruction
20044 @end itemize
20045
20046 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20047 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
20048
20049 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20050
20051 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20052
20053 @subsubheading Example
20054
20055 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20056
20057 @smallexample
20058 (gdb)
20059 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20060 ^done,
20061 asm_insns=[
20062 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20063 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20064 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20065 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20066 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20067 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20068 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20069 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20070 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20071 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20072 (gdb)
20073 @end smallexample
20074
20075 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20076 @code{main}.
20077
20078 @smallexample
20079 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20080 ^done,asm_insns=[
20081 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20082 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20083 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20084 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20085 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20086 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20087 [@dots{}]
20088 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20089 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20090 (gdb)
20091 @end smallexample
20092
20093 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20094
20095 @smallexample
20096 (gdb)
20097 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20098 ^done,asm_insns=[
20099 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20100 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20101 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20102 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20103 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20104 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20105 (gdb)
20106 @end smallexample
20107
20108 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20109
20110 @smallexample
20111 (gdb)
20112 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20113 ^done,asm_insns=[
20114 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20115 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20116 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20117 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20118 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20119 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20120 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20121 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20122 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20123 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20124 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20125 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20126 (gdb)
20127 @end smallexample
20128
20129
20130 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20131 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20132
20133 @subsubheading Synopsis
20134
20135 @smallexample
20136 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20137 @end smallexample
20138
20139 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20140 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20141 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20142
20143 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20144
20145 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20146 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20147 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20148
20149 @subsubheading Example
20150
20151 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20152 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20153 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20154 output.
20155
20156 @smallexample
20157 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20158 211^done,value="1"
20159 (gdb)
20160 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20161 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20162 (gdb)
20163 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20164 411^done,value="4"
20165 (gdb)
20166 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20167 511^done,value="4"
20168 (gdb)
20169 @end smallexample
20170
20171
20172 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20173 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20174
20175 @subsubheading Synopsis
20176
20177 @smallexample
20178 -data-list-changed-registers
20179 @end smallexample
20180
20181 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20182
20183 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20184
20185 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20186 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20187
20188 @subsubheading Example
20189
20190 On a PPC MBX board:
20191
20192 @smallexample
20193 (gdb)
20194 -exec-continue
20195 ^running
20196
20197 (gdb)
20198 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20199 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20200 (gdb)
20201 -data-list-changed-registers
20202 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20203 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20204 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20205 (gdb)
20206 @end smallexample
20207
20208
20209 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20210 @findex -data-list-register-names
20211
20212 @subsubheading Synopsis
20213
20214 @smallexample
20215 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20216 @end smallexample
20217
20218 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20219 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20220 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20221 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20222 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20223 include empty register names.
20224
20225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20226
20227 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20228 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20229 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20230
20231 @subsubheading Example
20232
20233 For the PPC MBX board:
20234 @smallexample
20235 (gdb)
20236 -data-list-register-names
20237 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20238 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20239 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20240 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20241 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20242 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20243 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20244 (gdb)
20245 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20246 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20247 (gdb)
20248 @end smallexample
20249
20250 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20251 @findex -data-list-register-values
20252
20253 @subsubheading Synopsis
20254
20255 @smallexample
20256 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20257 @end smallexample
20258
20259 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20260 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20261 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20262 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20263
20264 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20265
20266 @table @code
20267 @item x
20268 Hexadecimal
20269 @item o
20270 Octal
20271 @item t
20272 Binary
20273 @item d
20274 Decimal
20275 @item r
20276 Raw
20277 @item N
20278 Natural
20279 @end table
20280
20281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20282
20283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20284 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20285
20286 @subsubheading Example
20287
20288 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20289 don't appear in the actual output):
20290
20291 @smallexample
20292 (gdb)
20293 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20294 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20295 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20296 (gdb)
20297 -data-list-register-values x
20298 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20299 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20300 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20301 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20302 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20303 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20304 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20305 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20306 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20307 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20308 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20309 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20310 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20311 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20312 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20313 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20314 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20315 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20316 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20317 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20318 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20319 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20320 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20321 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20322 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20323 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20324 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20325 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20326 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20327 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20328 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20329 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20330 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20331 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20332 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20333 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20334 (gdb)
20335 @end smallexample
20336
20337
20338 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20339 @findex -data-read-memory
20340
20341 @subsubheading Synopsis
20342
20343 @smallexample
20344 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20345 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20346 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20347 @end smallexample
20348
20349 @noindent
20350 where:
20351
20352 @table @samp
20353 @item @var{address}
20354 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20355 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20356 quoted using the C convention.
20357
20358 @item @var{word-format}
20359 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20360 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20361 ,Output formats}).
20362
20363 @item @var{word-size}
20364 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20365
20366 @item @var{nr-rows}
20367 The number of rows in the output table.
20368
20369 @item @var{nr-cols}
20370 The number of columns in the output table.
20371
20372 @item @var{aschar}
20373 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20374 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20375 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20376 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20377
20378 @item @var{byte-offset}
20379 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20380 @end table
20381
20382 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20383 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20384 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20385 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20386 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20387 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20388 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20389 @samp{addr}.
20390
20391 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20392 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20393 @samp{prev-page}.
20394
20395 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20396
20397 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20398 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20399
20400 @subsubheading Example
20401
20402 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20403 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20404 word. Display each word in hex.
20405
20406 @smallexample
20407 (gdb)
20408 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20409 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20410 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20411 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20412 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20413 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20414 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20415 (gdb)
20416 @end smallexample
20417
20418 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20419 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20420
20421 @smallexample
20422 (gdb)
20423 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20424 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20425 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20426 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20427 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20428 (gdb)
20429 @end smallexample
20430
20431 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20432 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20433 used as the non-printable character.
20434
20435 @smallexample
20436 (gdb)
20437 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20438 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20439 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20440 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20441 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20442 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20443 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20444 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20445 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20446 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20447 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20448 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20449 (gdb)
20450 @end smallexample
20451
20452 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20453 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20454 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20455
20456 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20457
20458 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20459
20460 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20461
20462 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20463
20464 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20465
20466 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20467
20468 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20469
20470 @c @subheading -trace-find
20471
20472 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20473
20474 @c @subheading -trace-info
20475
20476 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20477
20478 @c @subheading -trace-list
20479
20480 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20481
20482 @c @subheading -trace-save
20483
20484 @c @subheading -trace-start
20485
20486 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20487
20488
20489 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20490 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20491 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20492
20493
20494 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20495 @findex -symbol-info-address
20496
20497 @subsubheading Synopsis
20498
20499 @smallexample
20500 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20501 @end smallexample
20502
20503 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20504
20505 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20506
20507 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20508
20509 @subsubheading Example
20510 N.A.
20511
20512
20513 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20514 @findex -symbol-info-file
20515
20516 @subsubheading Synopsis
20517
20518 @smallexample
20519 -symbol-info-file
20520 @end smallexample
20521
20522 Show the file for the symbol.
20523
20524 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20525
20526 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20527 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20528
20529 @subsubheading Example
20530 N.A.
20531
20532
20533 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20534 @findex -symbol-info-function
20535
20536 @subsubheading Synopsis
20537
20538 @smallexample
20539 -symbol-info-function
20540 @end smallexample
20541
20542 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20543
20544 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20545
20546 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20547
20548 @subsubheading Example
20549 N.A.
20550
20551
20552 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20553 @findex -symbol-info-line
20554
20555 @subsubheading Synopsis
20556
20557 @smallexample
20558 -symbol-info-line
20559 @end smallexample
20560
20561 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20562
20563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20564
20565 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20566 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20567
20568 @subsubheading Example
20569 N.A.
20570
20571
20572 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20573 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20574
20575 @subsubheading Synopsis
20576
20577 @smallexample
20578 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20579 @end smallexample
20580
20581 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20582
20583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20584
20585 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20586
20587 @subsubheading Example
20588 N.A.
20589
20590
20591 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20592 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20593
20594 @subsubheading Synopsis
20595
20596 @smallexample
20597 -symbol-list-functions
20598 @end smallexample
20599
20600 List the functions in the executable.
20601
20602 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20603
20604 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20605 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20606
20607 @subsubheading Example
20608 N.A.
20609
20610
20611 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20612 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20613
20614 @subsubheading Synopsis
20615
20616 @smallexample
20617 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20618 @end smallexample
20619
20620 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20621 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20622 ascending PC order.
20623
20624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20625
20626 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20627
20628 @subsubheading Example
20629 @smallexample
20630 (gdb)
20631 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20632 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20633 (gdb)
20634 @end smallexample
20635
20636
20637 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20638 @findex -symbol-list-types
20639
20640 @subsubheading Synopsis
20641
20642 @smallexample
20643 -symbol-list-types
20644 @end smallexample
20645
20646 List all the type names.
20647
20648 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20649
20650 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20651 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20652
20653 @subsubheading Example
20654 N.A.
20655
20656
20657 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20658 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20659
20660 @subsubheading Synopsis
20661
20662 @smallexample
20663 -symbol-list-variables
20664 @end smallexample
20665
20666 List all the global and static variable names.
20667
20668 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20669
20670 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20671
20672 @subsubheading Example
20673 N.A.
20674
20675
20676 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20677 @findex -symbol-locate
20678
20679 @subsubheading Synopsis
20680
20681 @smallexample
20682 -symbol-locate
20683 @end smallexample
20684
20685 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20686
20687 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20688
20689 @subsubheading Example
20690 N.A.
20691
20692
20693 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20694 @findex -symbol-type
20695
20696 @subsubheading Synopsis
20697
20698 @smallexample
20699 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20700 @end smallexample
20701
20702 Show type of @var{variable}.
20703
20704 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20705
20706 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20707 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20708
20709 @subsubheading Example
20710 N.A.
20711
20712
20713 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20714 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20715 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20716
20717 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20718 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20719
20720 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20721 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20722
20723 @subsubheading Synopsis
20724
20725 @smallexample
20726 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20727 @end smallexample
20728
20729 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20730 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20731 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20732 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20733 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20734 notification.
20735
20736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20737
20738 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20739
20740 @subsubheading Example
20741
20742 @smallexample
20743 (gdb)
20744 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20745 ^done
20746 (gdb)
20747 @end smallexample
20748
20749
20750 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20751 @findex -file-exec-file
20752
20753 @subsubheading Synopsis
20754
20755 @smallexample
20756 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20757 @end smallexample
20758
20759 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20760 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20761 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20762 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20763 notification.
20764
20765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20766
20767 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20768
20769 @subsubheading Example
20770
20771 @smallexample
20772 (gdb)
20773 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20774 ^done
20775 (gdb)
20776 @end smallexample
20777
20778
20779 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20780 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20781
20782 @subsubheading Synopsis
20783
20784 @smallexample
20785 -file-list-exec-sections
20786 @end smallexample
20787
20788 List the sections of the current executable file.
20789
20790 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20791
20792 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20793 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20794 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20795
20796 @subsubheading Example
20797 N.A.
20798
20799
20800 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20801 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20802
20803 @subsubheading Synopsis
20804
20805 @smallexample
20806 -file-list-exec-source-file
20807 @end smallexample
20808
20809 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20810 to the current source file for the current executable.
20811
20812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20813
20814 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20815
20816 @subsubheading Example
20817
20818 @smallexample
20819 (gdb)
20820 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20821 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20822 (gdb)
20823 @end smallexample
20824
20825
20826 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20827 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20828
20829 @subsubheading Synopsis
20830
20831 @smallexample
20832 -file-list-exec-source-files
20833 @end smallexample
20834
20835 List the source files for the current executable.
20836
20837 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
20838 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20839
20840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20841
20842 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20843 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20844
20845 @subsubheading Example
20846 @smallexample
20847 (gdb)
20848 -file-list-exec-source-files
20849 ^done,files=[
20850 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20851 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20852 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20853 (gdb)
20854 @end smallexample
20855
20856 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20857 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20858
20859 @subsubheading Synopsis
20860
20861 @smallexample
20862 -file-list-shared-libraries
20863 @end smallexample
20864
20865 List the shared libraries in the program.
20866
20867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20868
20869 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20870
20871 @subsubheading Example
20872 N.A.
20873
20874
20875 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20876 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20877
20878 @subsubheading Synopsis
20879
20880 @smallexample
20881 -file-list-symbol-files
20882 @end smallexample
20883
20884 List symbol files.
20885
20886 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20887
20888 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20889
20890 @subsubheading Example
20891 N.A.
20892
20893
20894 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20895 @findex -file-symbol-file
20896
20897 @subsubheading Synopsis
20898
20899 @smallexample
20900 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20901 @end smallexample
20902
20903 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20904 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20905 produced, except for a completion notification.
20906
20907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20908
20909 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20910
20911 @subsubheading Example
20912
20913 @smallexample
20914 (gdb)
20915 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20916 ^done
20917 (gdb)
20918 @end smallexample
20919
20920 @ignore
20921 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20922 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20923 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20924
20925 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20926
20927 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20928
20929 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20930
20931 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20932
20933 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20934
20935 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20936
20937 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20938
20939 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20940
20941 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20942 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20943 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20944
20945 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20946
20947 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20948
20949 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20950
20951 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20952 @end ignore
20953
20954
20955 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20956 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20957 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20958
20959
20960 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20961 @findex -target-attach
20962
20963 @subsubheading Synopsis
20964
20965 @smallexample
20966 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20967 @end smallexample
20968
20969 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20970
20971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20972
20973 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20974
20975 @subsubheading Example
20976 N.A.
20977
20978
20979 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20980 @findex -target-compare-sections
20981
20982 @subsubheading Synopsis
20983
20984 @smallexample
20985 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20986 @end smallexample
20987
20988 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20989 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20990
20991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20992
20993 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20994
20995 @subsubheading Example
20996 N.A.
20997
20998
20999 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21000 @findex -target-detach
21001
21002 @subsubheading Synopsis
21003
21004 @smallexample
21005 -target-detach
21006 @end smallexample
21007
21008 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21009 There's no output.
21010
21011 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21012
21013 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21014
21015 @subsubheading Example
21016
21017 @smallexample
21018 (gdb)
21019 -target-detach
21020 ^done
21021 (gdb)
21022 @end smallexample
21023
21024
21025 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21026 @findex -target-disconnect
21027
21028 @subsubheading Synopsis
21029
21030 @example
21031 -target-disconnect
21032 @end example
21033
21034 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21035 generally not resumed.
21036
21037 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21038
21039 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21040
21041 @subsubheading Example
21042
21043 @smallexample
21044 (gdb)
21045 -target-disconnect
21046 ^done
21047 (gdb)
21048 @end smallexample
21049
21050
21051 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21052 @findex -target-download
21053
21054 @subsubheading Synopsis
21055
21056 @smallexample
21057 -target-download
21058 @end smallexample
21059
21060 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21061 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21062
21063 @table @samp
21064 @item section
21065 The name of the section.
21066 @item section-sent
21067 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21068 @item section-size
21069 The size of the section.
21070 @item total-sent
21071 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21072 @item total-size
21073 The size of the overall executable to download.
21074 @end table
21075
21076 @noindent
21077 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21078 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21079
21080 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21081 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21082
21083 @table @samp
21084 @item section
21085 The name of the section.
21086 @item section-size
21087 The size of the section.
21088 @item total-size
21089 The size of the overall executable to download.
21090 @end table
21091
21092 @noindent
21093 At the end, a summary is printed.
21094
21095 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21096
21097 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21098
21099 @subsubheading Example
21100
21101 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21102 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21103
21104 @smallexample
21105 (gdb)
21106 -target-download
21107 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21108 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21109 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21110 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21111 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21112 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21113 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21114 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21115 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21116 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21117 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21118 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21119 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21120 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21121 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21122 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21123 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21124 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21125 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21126 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21127 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21128 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21129 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21130 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21131 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21132 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21133 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21134 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21135 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21136 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21137 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21138 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21139 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21140 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21141 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21142 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21143 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21144 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21145 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21146 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21147 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21148 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21149 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21150 write-rate="429"
21151 (gdb)
21152 @end smallexample
21153
21154
21155 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21156 @findex -target-exec-status
21157
21158 @subsubheading Synopsis
21159
21160 @smallexample
21161 -target-exec-status
21162 @end smallexample
21163
21164 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21165 not, for instance).
21166
21167 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21168
21169 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21170
21171 @subsubheading Example
21172 N.A.
21173
21174
21175 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21176 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21177
21178 @subsubheading Synopsis
21179
21180 @smallexample
21181 -target-list-available-targets
21182 @end smallexample
21183
21184 List the possible targets to connect to.
21185
21186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21187
21188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21189
21190 @subsubheading Example
21191 N.A.
21192
21193
21194 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21195 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21196
21197 @subsubheading Synopsis
21198
21199 @smallexample
21200 -target-list-current-targets
21201 @end smallexample
21202
21203 Describe the current target.
21204
21205 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21206
21207 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21208 other things).
21209
21210 @subsubheading Example
21211 N.A.
21212
21213
21214 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21215 @findex -target-list-parameters
21216
21217 @subsubheading Synopsis
21218
21219 @smallexample
21220 -target-list-parameters
21221 @end smallexample
21222
21223 @c ????
21224
21225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21226
21227 No equivalent.
21228
21229 @subsubheading Example
21230 N.A.
21231
21232
21233 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21234 @findex -target-select
21235
21236 @subsubheading Synopsis
21237
21238 @smallexample
21239 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21240 @end smallexample
21241
21242 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21243
21244 @table @samp
21245 @item @var{type}
21246 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21247 @item @var{parameters}
21248 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21249 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
21250 @end table
21251
21252 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21253 which the target program is, in the following form:
21254
21255 @smallexample
21256 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21257 args=[@var{arg list}]
21258 @end smallexample
21259
21260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21261
21262 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21263
21264 @subsubheading Example
21265
21266 @smallexample
21267 (gdb)
21268 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21269 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21270 (gdb)
21271 @end smallexample
21272
21273 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21274 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21275 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21276
21277 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21278
21279 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21280 @findex -gdb-exit
21281
21282 @subsubheading Synopsis
21283
21284 @smallexample
21285 -gdb-exit
21286 @end smallexample
21287
21288 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21289
21290 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21291
21292 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21293
21294 @subsubheading Example
21295
21296 @smallexample
21297 (gdb)
21298 -gdb-exit
21299 ^exit
21300 @end smallexample
21301
21302
21303 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21304 @findex -exec-abort
21305
21306 @subsubheading Synopsis
21307
21308 @smallexample
21309 -exec-abort
21310 @end smallexample
21311
21312 Kill the inferior running program.
21313
21314 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21315
21316 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21317
21318 @subsubheading Example
21319 N.A.
21320
21321
21322 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21323 @findex -gdb-set
21324
21325 @subsubheading Synopsis
21326
21327 @smallexample
21328 -gdb-set
21329 @end smallexample
21330
21331 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21332 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21333
21334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21335
21336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21337
21338 @subsubheading Example
21339
21340 @smallexample
21341 (gdb)
21342 -gdb-set $foo=3
21343 ^done
21344 (gdb)
21345 @end smallexample
21346
21347
21348 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21349 @findex -gdb-show
21350
21351 @subsubheading Synopsis
21352
21353 @smallexample
21354 -gdb-show
21355 @end smallexample
21356
21357 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21358
21359 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21360
21361 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21362
21363 @subsubheading Example
21364
21365 @smallexample
21366 (gdb)
21367 -gdb-show annotate
21368 ^done,value="0"
21369 (gdb)
21370 @end smallexample
21371
21372 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21373
21374
21375 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21376 @findex -gdb-version
21377
21378 @subsubheading Synopsis
21379
21380 @smallexample
21381 -gdb-version
21382 @end smallexample
21383
21384 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21385
21386 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21387
21388 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21389 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21390
21391 @subsubheading Example
21392
21393 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21394 @c box in TeX.
21395 @smallexample
21396 (gdb)
21397 -gdb-version
21398 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21399 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21400 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21401 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21402 ~ certain conditions.
21403 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21404 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21405 ~ details.
21406 ~This GDB was configured as
21407 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21408 ^done
21409 (gdb)
21410 @end smallexample
21411
21412 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21413 @findex -interpreter-exec
21414
21415 @subheading Synopsis
21416
21417 @smallexample
21418 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21419 @end smallexample
21420 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21421
21422 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21423
21424 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21425
21426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21427
21428 @subheading Example
21429
21430 @smallexample
21431 (gdb)
21432 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21433 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21434 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21435 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21436 ^done
21437 (gdb)
21438 @end smallexample
21439
21440 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21441 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21442
21443 @subheading Synopsis
21444
21445 @smallexample
21446 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21447 @end smallexample
21448
21449 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21450
21451 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21452
21453 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21454
21455 @subheading Example
21456
21457 @smallexample
21458 (gdb)
21459 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21460 ^done
21461 (gdb)
21462 @end smallexample
21463
21464 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21465 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21466
21467 @subheading Synopsis
21468
21469 @smallexample
21470 -inferior-tty-show
21471 @end smallexample
21472
21473 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21474
21475 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21476
21477 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21478
21479 @subheading Example
21480
21481 @smallexample
21482 (gdb)
21483 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21484 ^done
21485 (gdb)
21486 -inferior-tty-show
21487 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21488 (gdb)
21489 @end smallexample
21490
21491 @node Annotations
21492 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21493
21494 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21495 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21496 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21497 relatively high level.
21498
21499 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21500 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21501
21502 @ignore
21503 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21504 @end ignore
21505
21506 @menu
21507 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21508 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21509 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21510 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21511 * Annotations for Running::
21512 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21513 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21514 @end menu
21515
21516 @node Annotations Overview
21517 @section What is an Annotation?
21518 @cindex annotations
21519
21520 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21521 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21522 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21523 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21524 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21525 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21526 cannot contain newline characters.
21527
21528 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21529 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21530 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21531 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21532 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21533 means those three characters as output.
21534
21535 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21536 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21537 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21538 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21539 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21540 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21541 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21542 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21543 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21544
21545 @table @code
21546 @kindex set annotate
21547 @item set annotate @var{level}
21548 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21549 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21550
21551 @item show annotate
21552 @kindex show annotate
21553 Show the current annotation level.
21554 @end table
21555
21556 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21557
21558 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21559
21560 @smallexample
21561 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21562 GNU gdb 6.0
21563 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21564 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21565 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21566 under certain conditions.
21567 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21568 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21569 for details.
21570 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21571
21572 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21573 (@value{GDBP})
21574 ^Z^Zprompt
21575 @kbd{quit}
21576
21577 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21578 $
21579 @end smallexample
21580
21581 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21582 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21583 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21584 output from @value{GDBN}.
21585
21586 @node Prompting
21587 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21588
21589 @cindex annotations for prompts
21590 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21591 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21592 over, etc.
21593
21594 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21595 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21596 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21597 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21598 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21599 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21600 features the following annotations:
21601
21602 @smallexample
21603 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21604 ^Z^Zprompt
21605 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21606 @end smallexample
21607
21608 The input types are
21609
21610 @table @code
21611 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21612 @findex prompt annotation
21613 @findex post-prompt annotation
21614 @item prompt
21615 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21616
21617 @findex pre-commands annotation
21618 @findex commands annotation
21619 @findex post-commands annotation
21620 @item commands
21621 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21622 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21623
21624 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21625 @findex overload-choice annotation
21626 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21627 @item overload-choice
21628 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21629
21630 @findex pre-query annotation
21631 @findex query annotation
21632 @findex post-query annotation
21633 @item query
21634 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21635
21636 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21637 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21638 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21639 @item prompt-for-continue
21640 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21641 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21642 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21643 presence of annotations.
21644 @end table
21645
21646 @node Errors
21647 @section Errors
21648 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21649
21650 @findex quit annotation
21651 @smallexample
21652 ^Z^Zquit
21653 @end smallexample
21654
21655 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21656
21657 @findex error annotation
21658 @smallexample
21659 ^Z^Zerror
21660 @end smallexample
21661
21662 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21663
21664 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21665 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21666 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21667 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21668 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21669 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21670 to the top level.
21671
21672 @findex error-begin annotation
21673 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21674
21675 @smallexample
21676 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21677 @end smallexample
21678
21679 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21680 message.
21681
21682 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21683 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21684 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21685
21686 @node Invalidation
21687 @section Invalidation Notices
21688
21689 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21690 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21691 changed.
21692
21693 @table @code
21694 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21695 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21696
21697 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21698 have changed.
21699
21700 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21701 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21702
21703 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21704 deleted a breakpoint.
21705 @end table
21706
21707 @node Annotations for Running
21708 @section Running the Program
21709 @cindex annotations for running programs
21710
21711 @findex starting annotation
21712 @findex stopping annotation
21713 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21714 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21715
21716 @smallexample
21717 ^Z^Zstarting
21718 @end smallexample
21719
21720 is output. When the program stops,
21721
21722 @smallexample
21723 ^Z^Zstopped
21724 @end smallexample
21725
21726 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21727 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21728
21729 @table @code
21730 @findex exited annotation
21731 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21732 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21733 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21734
21735 @findex signalled annotation
21736 @findex signal-name annotation
21737 @findex signal-name-end annotation
21738 @findex signal-string annotation
21739 @findex signal-string-end annotation
21740 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21741 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21742 annotation continues:
21743
21744 @smallexample
21745 @var{intro-text}
21746 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21747 @var{name}
21748 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21749 @var{middle-text}
21750 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21751 @var{string}
21752 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21753 @var{end-text}
21754 @end smallexample
21755
21756 @noindent
21757 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21758 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21759 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21760 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21761 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21762
21763 @findex signal annotation
21764 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21765 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21766 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21767 terminated with it.
21768
21769 @findex breakpoint annotation
21770 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21771 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21772
21773 @findex watchpoint annotation
21774 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21775 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21776 @end table
21777
21778 @node Source Annotations
21779 @section Displaying Source
21780 @cindex annotations for source display
21781
21782 @findex source annotation
21783 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21784
21785 @smallexample
21786 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21787 @end smallexample
21788
21789 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21790 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21791 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21792 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21793 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21794 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21795 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21796 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21797 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21798 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21799 depend on the language).
21800
21801 @node GDB Bugs
21802 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21803 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21804 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21805
21806 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21807
21808 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21809 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21810 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21811 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21812
21813 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21814 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21815
21816 @menu
21817 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21818 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21819 @end menu
21820
21821 @node Bug Criteria
21822 @section Have you found a bug?
21823 @cindex bug criteria
21824
21825 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21826
21827 @itemize @bullet
21828 @cindex fatal signal
21829 @cindex debugger crash
21830 @cindex crash of debugger
21831 @item
21832 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21833 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21834
21835 @cindex error on valid input
21836 @item
21837 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21838 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21839 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21840
21841 @cindex invalid input
21842 @item
21843 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21844 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21845 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21846 for traditional practice''.
21847
21848 @item
21849 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21850 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21851 @end itemize
21852
21853 @node Bug Reporting
21854 @section How to report bugs
21855 @cindex bug reports
21856 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21857
21858 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21859 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21860 contact that organization first.
21861
21862 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21863 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21864 distribution.
21865 @c should add a web page ref...
21866
21867 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21868 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
21869 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21870 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21871 be used.
21872
21873 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21874 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21875 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21876 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21877
21878 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21879 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21880 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21881 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21882 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21883 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21884 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21885 bug reports to the mailing list.
21886
21887 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21888 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21889 fact or leave it out, state it!
21890
21891 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21892 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21893 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21894 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21895 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21896 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21897 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21898 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21899 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21900
21901 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21902 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21903 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21904 self-contained.
21905
21906 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21907 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21908 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21909 bugs properly.
21910
21911 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21912
21913 @itemize @bullet
21914 @item
21915 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21916 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21917 version}.
21918
21919 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21920 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21921
21922 @item
21923 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21924 version number.
21925
21926 @item
21927 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21928 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21929
21930 @item
21931 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21932 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21933 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
21934 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
21935 compilers.
21936
21937 @item
21938 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21939 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21940 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21941 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21942
21943 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21944 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21945
21946 @item
21947 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21948 reproduce the bug.
21949
21950 @item
21951 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21952 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21953
21954 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21955 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21956 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21957 a chance to make a mistake.
21958
21959 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21960 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21961 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21962 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21963 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21964 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21965 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21966 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21967
21968 @pindex script
21969 @cindex recording a session script
21970 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21971 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21972 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21973 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21974
21975 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21976 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21977
21978 @item
21979 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21980 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21981 it by context, not by line number.
21982
21983 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21984 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21985
21986 @end itemize
21987
21988 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21989
21990 @itemize @bullet
21991 @item
21992 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21993
21994 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21995 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21996 changes will not affect it.
21997
21998 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21999 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22000 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22001 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22002
22003 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22004 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22005 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22006 less time, and so on.
22007
22008 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22009 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22010
22011 @item
22012 A patch for the bug.
22013
22014 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22015 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22016 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22017 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22018
22019 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22020 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22021 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22022 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22023
22024 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22025 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22026 help us to understand.
22027
22028 @item
22029 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22030
22031 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22032 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22033 @end itemize
22034
22035 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22036 @c and consists of the two following files:
22037 @c rluser.texinfo
22038 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22039 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22040 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22041 @include rluser.texi
22042 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22043
22044
22045 @node Formatting Documentation
22046 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22047
22048 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22049 @cindex reference card
22050 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22051 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22052 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22053 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22054 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22055 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22056
22057 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22058 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22059
22060 @smallexample
22061 make refcard.dvi
22062 @end smallexample
22063
22064 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22065 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22066 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22067 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22068 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22069
22070 @cindex documentation
22071
22072 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22073 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22074 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22075 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22076 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22077 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22078
22079 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22080 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22081 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22082 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22083 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22084 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22085 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22086 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22087
22088 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22089 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22090 @code{makeinfo}.
22091
22092 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22093 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22094 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22095
22096 @smallexample
22097 cd gdb
22098 make gdb.info
22099 @end smallexample
22100
22101 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22102 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22103 Texinfo definitions file.
22104
22105 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22106 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22107 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22108 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22109 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22110 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22111 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22112
22113 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22114 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22115 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22116 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22117 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22118 directory.
22119
22120 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22121 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
22122 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22123 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22124
22125 @smallexample
22126 make gdb.dvi
22127 @end smallexample
22128
22129 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22130
22131 @node Installing GDB
22132 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22133 @cindex installation
22134
22135 @menu
22136 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22137 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22138 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22139 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22140 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22141 @end menu
22142
22143 @node Requirements
22144 @section Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22145 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22146
22147 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22148 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22149
22150 @heading Tools/packages necessary for building @value{GDBN}
22151 @table @asis
22152 @item ISO C90 compiler
22153 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22154 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22155
22156 @end table
22157
22158 @heading Tools/packages optional for building @value{GDBN}
22159 @table @asis
22160 @item Expat
22161 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22162 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22163 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22164 The @code{configure} script will search for this library in several
22165 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22166 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22167
22168 Expat is used currently only used to implement some remote-specific
22169 features.
22170
22171 @end table
22172
22173 @node Running Configure
22174 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22175 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22176 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
22177 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22178 build the @code{gdb} program.
22179 @iftex
22180 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22181 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22182 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22183 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22184 @end iftex
22185
22186 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22187 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22188 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22189
22190 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22191 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22192
22193 @table @code
22194 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22195 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22196
22197 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22198 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22199
22200 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22201 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22202
22203 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22204 @sc{gnu} include files
22205
22206 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22207 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22208
22209 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22210 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22211
22212 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22213 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22214
22215 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22216 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22217
22218 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22219 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22220 @end table
22221
22222 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
22223 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22224 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22225
22226 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22227 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
22228 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22229 argument.
22230
22231 For example:
22232
22233 @smallexample
22234 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22235 ./configure @var{host}
22236 make
22237 @end smallexample
22238
22239 @noindent
22240 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22241 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22242 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
22243 correct value by examining your system.)
22244
22245 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22246 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22247 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22248 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22249
22250 @need 750
22251 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22252 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22253 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22254
22255 @smallexample
22256 sh configure @var{host}
22257 @end smallexample
22258
22259 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
22260 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22261 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
22262 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22263 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22264
22265 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
22266 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22267 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22268 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22269 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22270 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22271 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22272 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22273 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22274
22275 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22276 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22277 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22278 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22279 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22280
22281 @node Separate Objdir
22282 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22283
22284 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22285 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22286 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22287 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22288 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22289 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22290 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22291 program specified there.
22292
22293 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
22294 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22295 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
22296 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
22297 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22298 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22299
22300 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22301 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22302
22303 @smallexample
22304 @group
22305 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22306 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22307 cd ../gdb-sun4
22308 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22309 make
22310 @end group
22311 @end smallexample
22312
22313 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22314 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22315 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22316 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22317 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22318 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22319
22320 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22321 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22322 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22323 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22324 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22325
22326 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22327 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22328 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22329 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22330 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22331 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
22332
22333 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22334 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22335 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22336
22337 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
22338 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22339 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22340 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22341 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22342
22343 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22344 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22345 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22346 with each other.
22347
22348 @node Config Names
22349 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
22350
22351 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
22352 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22353 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22354 of information in the following pattern:
22355
22356 @smallexample
22357 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22358 @end smallexample
22359
22360 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22361 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22362 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22363
22364 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22365 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22366 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22367 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22368 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22369 abbreviations---for example:
22370
22371 @smallexample
22372 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22373 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22374 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22375 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22376 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22377 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22378 % sh config.sub sun4
22379 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22380 % sh config.sub sun3
22381 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22382 % sh config.sub i986v
22383 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22384 @end smallexample
22385
22386 @noindent
22387 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22388 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22389
22390 @node Configure Options
22391 @section @code{configure} options
22392
22393 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
22394 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
22395 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22396 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
22397
22398 @smallexample
22399 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22400 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22401 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22402 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22403 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22404 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22405 @var{host}
22406 @end smallexample
22407
22408 @noindent
22409 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22410 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22411 @samp{--}.
22412
22413 @table @code
22414 @item --help
22415 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
22416
22417 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22418 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22419 @file{@var{dir}}.
22420
22421 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22422 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22423 @file{@var{dir}}.
22424
22425 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22426 @need 2000
22427 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22428 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22429 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22430 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22431 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22432 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22433 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
22434 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22435 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
22436 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22437 @var{dirname}.
22438
22439 @item --norecursion
22440 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
22441 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22442
22443 @item --target=@var{target}
22444 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22445 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22446 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22447
22448 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22449
22450 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22451 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22452
22453 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22454 @end table
22455
22456 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22457 needed for special purposes only.
22458
22459 @node Maintenance Commands
22460 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22461 @cindex maintenance commands
22462 @cindex internal commands
22463
22464 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22465 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22466 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22467 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22468 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22469
22470 @table @code
22471 @kindex maint agent
22472 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22473 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22474 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22475 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22476
22477 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22478 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22479 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22480 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22481 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22482 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22483 is shown:
22484
22485 @table @code
22486 @item breakpoint
22487 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22488
22489 @item watchpoint
22490 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22491
22492 @item longjmp
22493 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22494 @code{longjmp} calls.
22495
22496 @item longjmp resume
22497 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22498
22499 @item until
22500 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22501
22502 @item finish
22503 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22504
22505 @item shlib events
22506 Shared library events.
22507
22508 @end table
22509
22510 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22511 @item maint check-symtabs
22512 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22513
22514 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22515 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22516 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22517
22518 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22519 @item maint cplus namespace
22520 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22521
22522 @kindex maint demangle
22523 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22524 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C manled @var{name}.
22525
22526 @kindex maint deprecate
22527 @kindex maint undeprecate
22528 @cindex deprecated commands
22529 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22530 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22531 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22532 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22533 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22534 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22535 the replacement as part of the warning.
22536
22537 @kindex maint dump-me
22538 @item maint dump-me
22539 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22540 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22541 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22542 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22543
22544 @kindex maint internal-error
22545 @kindex maint internal-warning
22546 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22547 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22548 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22549 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22550 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22551 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22552 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22553 @value{GDBN} session.
22554
22555 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22556 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22557
22558 Here's an example of using @code{indernal-error}:
22559
22560 @smallexample
22561 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22562 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22563 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22564 debugging may prove unreliable.
22565 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22566 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22567 (@value{GDBP})
22568 @end smallexample
22569
22570 @kindex maint packet
22571 @item maint packet @var{text}
22572 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22573 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22574 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22575 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22576 checksum.
22577
22578 @kindex maint print architecture
22579 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22580 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22581 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22582
22583 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22584 @item maint print dummy-frames
22585 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22586
22587 @smallexample
22588 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22589 @dots{}
22590 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22591 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22592 58 return (a + b);
22593 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22594 @dots{}
22595 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22596 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22597 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22598 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22599 (@value{GDBP})
22600 @end smallexample
22601
22602 Takes an optional file parameter.
22603
22604 @kindex maint print registers
22605 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22606 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22607 @kindex maint print register-groups
22608 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22609 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22610 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22611 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22612 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22613
22614 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22615 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22616 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22617 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22618 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22619 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22620
22621 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22622 write the information.
22623
22624 @kindex maint print reggroups
22625 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22626 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22627 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22628 information.
22629
22630 The register groups info looks like this:
22631
22632 @smallexample
22633 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22634 Group Type
22635 general user
22636 float user
22637 all user
22638 vector user
22639 system user
22640 save internal
22641 restore internal
22642 @end smallexample
22643
22644 @kindex flushregs
22645 @item flushregs
22646 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22647
22648 @kindex maint print objfiles
22649 @cindex info for known object files
22650 @item maint print objfiles
22651 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22652 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22653 and symtabs.
22654
22655 @kindex maint print statistics
22656 @cindex bcache statistics
22657 @item maint print statistics
22658 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22659 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22660 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22661 of minimal, partical, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22662 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22663 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22664 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22665 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22666 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22667 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22668 lengths.
22669
22670 @kindex maint print type
22671 @cindex type chain of a data type
22672 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22673 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22674 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22675 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22676 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22677 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22678
22679 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22680 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22681 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22682 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22683 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22684
22685 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22686 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22687 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22688 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22689 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22690 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22691 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22692 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22693 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22694
22695 @kindex maint set profile
22696 @kindex maint show profile
22697 @cindex profiling GDB
22698 @item maint set profile
22699 @itemx maint show profile
22700 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22701
22702 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22703 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22704 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22705 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22706 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22707 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22708 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22709
22710 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22711 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22712
22713 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22714 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22715 @item maint show-debug-regs
22716 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22717 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22718 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
22719 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22720 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22721
22722 @kindex maint space
22723 @cindex memory used by commands
22724 @item maint space
22725 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22726 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22727 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22728 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22729 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22730
22731 @kindex maint time
22732 @cindex time of command execution
22733 @item maint time
22734 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22735 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22736 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22737 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22738 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22739
22740 @kindex maint translate-address
22741 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22742 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22743 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22744 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22745 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22746 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22747 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22748
22749 @end table
22750
22751 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22752 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22753
22754 @table @code
22755 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22756 @kindex set watchdog
22757 @cindex watchdog timer
22758 @cindex timeout for commands
22759 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22760 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22761 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22762
22763 @item show watchdog
22764 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22765 @end table
22766
22767 @node Remote Protocol
22768 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22769
22770 @menu
22771 * Overview::
22772 * Packets::
22773 * Stop Reply Packets::
22774 * General Query Packets::
22775 * Register Packet Format::
22776 * Tracepoint Packets::
22777 * Interrupts::
22778 * Examples::
22779 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
22780 * Memory map format::
22781 @end menu
22782
22783 @node Overview
22784 @section Overview
22785
22786 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22787 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22788 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22789 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22790
22791 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22792 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22793
22794 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22795 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22796 @cindex remote serial protocol
22797 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22798 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22799 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22800 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22801
22802 @smallexample
22803 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22804 @end smallexample
22805 @noindent
22806
22807 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22808 @noindent
22809 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22810 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22811 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22812
22813 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22814 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22815
22816 @smallexample
22817 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22818 @end smallexample
22819
22820 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22821 @noindent
22822 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22823 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22824 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22825
22826 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22827 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22828 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22829 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22830 retransmission):
22831
22832 @smallexample
22833 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22834 <- @code{+}
22835 @end smallexample
22836 @noindent
22837
22838 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22839 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22840 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22841 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22842
22843 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22844 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22845 exceptions).
22846
22847 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22848 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22849 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22850 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22851
22852 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22853 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22854 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22855
22856 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22857 @anchor{Binary Data}
22858 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22859 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22860 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22861 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22862 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22863 binary data.
22864
22865 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22866 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22867 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22868 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22869 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22870 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22871 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22872 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22873 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22874 (described next).
22875
22876 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22877 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22878 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22879 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22880 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22881 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22882 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22883
22884 So:
22885 @smallexample
22886 "@code{0* }"
22887 @end smallexample
22888 @noindent
22889 means the same as "0000".
22890
22891 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22892 error number. That number is not well defined.
22893
22894 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22895 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22896 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22897 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22898 on that response.
22899
22900 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22901 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22902 optional.
22903
22904 @node Packets
22905 @section Packets
22906
22907 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22908 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22909 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
22910 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22911
22912 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22913 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22914 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22915 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22916 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22917 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22918 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22919 @var{baz}. GDB does not transmit a space character between the
22920 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22921 @var{baz}.
22922
22923 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22924 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22925
22926 Here are the packet descriptions.
22927
22928 @table @samp
22929
22930 @item !
22931 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22932 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22933 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22934 debugged.
22935
22936 Reply:
22937 @table @samp
22938 @item OK
22939 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22940 @end table
22941
22942 @item ?
22943 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22944 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22945 step and continue.
22946
22947 Reply:
22948 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22949
22950 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22951 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22952 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22953 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22954 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22955
22956 Reply:
22957 @table @samp
22958 @item OK
22959 The arguments were set.
22960 @item E @var{NN}
22961 An error occurred.
22962 @end table
22963
22964 @item b @var{baud}
22965 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22966 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22967 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22968
22969 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22970 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22971 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22972
22973 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22974 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22975 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22976 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22977 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22978
22979 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22980 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22981 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22982 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22983
22984 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22985 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22986
22987 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22988 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22989 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22990 resume at current address.
22991
22992 Reply:
22993 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22994
22995 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22996 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22997 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22998 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22999
23000 Reply:
23001 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23002
23003 @item d
23004 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23005 Toggle debug flag.
23006
23007 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23008 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23009
23010 @item D
23011 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23012 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23013 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23014
23015 Reply:
23016 @table @samp
23017 @item OK
23018 for success
23019 @item E @var{NN}
23020 for an error
23021 @end table
23022
23023 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23024 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23025 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23026 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23027 remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
23028
23029 @item g
23030 @anchor{read registers packet}
23031 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23032 Read general registers.
23033
23034 Reply:
23035 @table @samp
23036 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23037 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23038 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23039 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23040 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
23041 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
23042 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23043 @item E @var{NN}
23044 for an error.
23045 @end table
23046
23047 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23048 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23049 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23050 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23051
23052 Reply:
23053 @table @samp
23054 @item OK
23055 for success
23056 @item E @var{NN}
23057 for an error
23058 @end table
23059
23060 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23061 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23062 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23063 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23064 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23065 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23066 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23067
23068 Reply:
23069 @table @samp
23070 @item OK
23071 for success
23072 @item E @var{NN}
23073 for an error
23074 @end table
23075
23076 @c FIXME: JTC:
23077 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23078 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23079 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23080 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23081 @c described. For example:
23082 @c
23083 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23084 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23085 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23086 @c
23087 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23088 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23089 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23090
23091 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23092 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23093 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23094 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23095 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23096 step starting at that address.
23097
23098 @item I
23099 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23100 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23101 step packet}.
23102
23103 @item k
23104 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23105 Kill request.
23106
23107 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23108 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23109 thread?)}.
23110
23111 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23112 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23113 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23114 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23115
23116 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23117 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23118 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23119 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23120 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23121 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23122 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23123 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23124
23125 Reply:
23126 @table @samp
23127 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23128 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23129 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23130 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23131 @item E @var{NN}
23132 @var{NN} is errno
23133 @end table
23134
23135 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23136 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23137 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23138 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23139 hexadecimal number.
23140
23141 Reply:
23142 @table @samp
23143 @item OK
23144 for success
23145 @item E @var{NN}
23146 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23147 written).
23148 @end table
23149
23150 @item p @var{n}
23151 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23152 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23153 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23154 register value is encoded.
23155
23156 Reply:
23157 @table @samp
23158 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23159 the register's value
23160 @item E @var{NN}
23161 for an error
23162 @item
23163 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23164 @end table
23165
23166 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23167 @anchor{write register packet}
23168 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23169 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23170 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23171 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23172
23173 Reply:
23174 @table @samp
23175 @item OK
23176 for success
23177 @item E @var{NN}
23178 for an error
23179 @end table
23180
23181 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23182 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23183 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23184 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23185 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23186 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23187
23188 @item r
23189 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23190 Reset the entire system.
23191
23192 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23193
23194 @item R @var{XX}
23195 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23196 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23197 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23198
23199 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23200
23201 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23202 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23203 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23204 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23205
23206 Reply:
23207 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23208
23209 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23210 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23211 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23212 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23213 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23214
23215 Reply:
23216 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23217
23218 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23219 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23220 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23221 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23222 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23223
23224 @item T @var{XX}
23225 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23226 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23227
23228 Reply:
23229 @table @samp
23230 @item OK
23231 thread is still alive
23232 @item E @var{NN}
23233 thread is dead
23234 @end table
23235
23236 @item v
23237 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23238 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23239
23240 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23241 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23242 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23243 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23244 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23245 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23246 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23247 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23248
23249 @table @samp
23250 @item c
23251 Continue.
23252 @item C @var{sig}
23253 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23254 @item s
23255 Step.
23256 @item S @var{sig}
23257 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23258 @end table
23259
23260 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23261 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23262
23263 Reply:
23264 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23265
23266 @item vCont?
23267 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23268 Request a list of actions supporetd by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23269
23270 Reply:
23271 @table @samp
23272 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23273 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23274 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23275 @item
23276 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23277 @end table
23278
23279 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23280 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23281 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23282 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23283 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23284 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory map
23285 format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23286 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23287 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23288 packet is received.
23289
23290 Reply:
23291 @table @samp
23292 @item OK
23293 for success
23294 @item E @var{NN}
23295 for an error
23296 @end table
23297
23298 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23299 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23300 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23301 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23302 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23303 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23304 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23305 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23306 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23307 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23308 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23309 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23310
23311
23312 Reply:
23313 @table @samp
23314 @item OK
23315 for success
23316 @item E.memtype
23317 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23318 @item E @var{NN}
23319 for an error
23320 @end table
23321
23322 @item vFlashDone
23323 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23324 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23325 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23326 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23327 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23328 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23329 request is completed.
23330
23331 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23332 @anchor{X packet}
23333 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23334 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23335 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23336 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23337
23338 Reply:
23339 @table @samp
23340 @item OK
23341 for success
23342 @item E @var{NN}
23343 for an error
23344 @end table
23345
23346 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23347 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23348 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23349 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23350 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23351 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23352 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23353 @var{length} bytes.
23354
23355 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23356 separately.
23357
23358 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23359 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23360 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23361 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23362 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23363 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23364
23365 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23366 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23367 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23368 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23369 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23370 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23371
23372 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23373 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23374 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23375 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23376 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23377
23378 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23379 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23380 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23381 target, is not defined.}
23382
23383 Reply:
23384 @table @samp
23385 @item OK
23386 success
23387 @item
23388 not supported
23389 @item E @var{NN}
23390 for an error
23391 @end table
23392
23393 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23394 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23395 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23396 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23397 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23398 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23399
23400 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23401 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23402
23403 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23404 movement.}
23405
23406 Reply:
23407 @table @samp
23408 @item OK
23409 success
23410 @item
23411 not supported
23412 @item E @var{NN}
23413 for an error
23414 @end table
23415
23416 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23417 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23418 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23419 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23420 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23421
23422 Reply:
23423 @table @samp
23424 @item OK
23425 success
23426 @item
23427 not supported
23428 @item E @var{NN}
23429 for an error
23430 @end table
23431
23432 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23433 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23434 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23435 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23436 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23437
23438 Reply:
23439 @table @samp
23440 @item OK
23441 success
23442 @item
23443 not supported
23444 @item E @var{NN}
23445 for an error
23446 @end table
23447
23448 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23449 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23450 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23451 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23452 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23453
23454 Reply:
23455 @table @samp
23456 @item OK
23457 success
23458 @item
23459 not supported
23460 @item E @var{NN}
23461 for an error
23462 @end table
23463
23464 @end table
23465
23466 @node Stop Reply Packets
23467 @section Stop Reply Packets
23468 @cindex stop reply packets
23469
23470 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23471 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23472 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23473 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23474 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23475 @value{GDBN} source code.
23476
23477 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23478 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23479 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23480 components.
23481
23482 @table @samp
23483
23484 @item S @var{AA}
23485 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23486 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23487 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23488
23489 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23490 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23491 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23492 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23493 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23494 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23495 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23496 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23497 @enumerate
23498 @item
23499 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23500 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23501 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23502 two-digit hex number.
23503 @item
23504 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23505 hex.
23506 @item
23507 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23508 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23509 hex.
23510 @item
23511 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23512 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23513 future.
23514 @end enumerate
23515
23516 @item W @var{AA}
23517 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23518 applicable to certain targets.
23519
23520 @item X @var{AA}
23521 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23522
23523 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23524 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23525 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23526 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23527 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23528
23529 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23530 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23531 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23532 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23533 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
23534 system calls.
23535
23536 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23537 this very system call.
23538
23539 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23540 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23541 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23542 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23543 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O remote
23544 protocol extension}, for more details.
23545
23546 @end table
23547
23548 @node General Query Packets
23549 @section General Query Packets
23550 @cindex remote query requests
23551
23552 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23553 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23554 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23555 sending information to and from the stub.
23556
23557 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23558 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23559 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23560 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23561 conventions:
23562
23563 @itemize @bullet
23564 @item
23565 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23566 @item
23567 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23568 letter.
23569 @item
23570 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23571 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23572 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23573 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23574 @end itemize
23575
23576 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23577 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23578 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23579 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23580 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23581 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23582 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23583 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23584 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23585 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23586 packet.}.
23587
23588 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23589 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23590 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23591 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23592 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23593
23594 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23595
23596 @table @samp
23597
23598 @item qC
23599 @cindex current thread, remote request
23600 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23601 Return the current thread id.
23602
23603 Reply:
23604 @table @samp
23605 @item QC @var{pid}
23606 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23607 @item @r{(anything else)}
23608 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23609 @end table
23610
23611 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23612 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23613 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23614 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23615 Reply:
23616 @table @samp
23617 @item E @var{NN}
23618 An error (such as memory fault)
23619 @item C @var{crc32}
23620 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23621 @end table
23622
23623 @item qfThreadInfo
23624 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23625 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23626 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23627 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23628 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23629 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23630 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23631 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23632 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23633 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23634
23635 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23636
23637 Reply:
23638 @table @samp
23639 @item m @var{id}
23640 A single thread id
23641 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23642 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23643 @item l
23644 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23645 @end table
23646
23647 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23648 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23649 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23650 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23651 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23652
23653 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23654 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23655 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23656 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23657 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23658
23659 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23660 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23661
23662 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23663 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23664 information associated with the variable.)
23665
23666 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
23667 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23668 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23669 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23670 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23671 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23672
23673 Reply:
23674 @table @samp
23675 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23676 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23677 local storage requested.
23678
23679 @item E @var{nn}
23680 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23681
23682 @item
23683 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23684 @end table
23685
23686 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23687 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23688 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23689 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23690 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23691 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23692 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23693
23694 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23695
23696 Reply:
23697 @table @samp
23698 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23699 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23700 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23701 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23702 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23703 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23704 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23705 @end table
23706
23707 @item qOffsets
23708 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23709 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23710 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23711 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23712 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23713 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23714
23715 Reply:
23716 @table @samp
23717 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23718 @end table
23719
23720 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23721 @cindex thread information, remote request
23722 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23723 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23724 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23725
23726 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23727 (see below).
23728
23729 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23730
23731 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
23732 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
23733 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23734 @anchor{QPassSignals}
23735 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
23736 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
23737 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
23738 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
23739 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
23740 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
23741 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
23742 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
23743 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
23744
23745 Reply:
23746 @table @samp
23747 @item OK
23748 The request succeeded.
23749
23750 @item E @var{nn}
23751 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23752
23753 @item
23754 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
23755 the stub.
23756 @end table
23757
23758 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
23759 command (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
23760 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23761 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23762
23763 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23764 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23765 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23766 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23767 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23768 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23769 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23770 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23771 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23772
23773 Reply:
23774 @table @samp
23775 @item OK
23776 A command response with no output.
23777 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23778 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23779 @item E @var{NN}
23780 Indicate a badly formed request.
23781 @item
23782 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23783 @end table
23784
23785 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23786 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23787 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23788 packets.)
23789
23790 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23791 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23792 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23793 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23794 @anchor{qSupported}
23795 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23796 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23797 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23798 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23799 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23800 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23801 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23802 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23803 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23804 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23805 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23806 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23807 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23808 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23809
23810 Reply:
23811 @table @samp
23812 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23813 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23814 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23815 possible forms).
23816 @item
23817 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23818 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23819 @end table
23820
23821 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23822 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23823 are:
23824
23825 @table @samp
23826 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23827 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23828 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23829 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23830 @item @var{name}+
23831 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23832 need an associated value.
23833 @item @var{name}-
23834 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23835 @item @var{name}?
23836 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23837 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23838 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23839 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23840 @end table
23841
23842 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23843 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23844 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23845 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23846 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23847
23848 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23849 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23850 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23851 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23852 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23853 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23854 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23855 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23856 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23857 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23858 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23859 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23860 all the features it supports.
23861
23862 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23863 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23864
23865 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23866 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23867 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23868 form response.
23869
23870 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23871 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23872 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23873 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23874
23875 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23876 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23877 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23878 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23879 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23880
23881 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23882
23883 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.2 0.2 0.2
23884 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23885 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23886 @item Feature Name
23887 @tab Value Required
23888 @tab Default
23889 @tab Probe Allowed
23890
23891 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23892 @tab Yes
23893 @tab @samp{-}
23894 @tab No
23895
23896 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23897 @tab No
23898 @tab @samp{-}
23899 @tab Yes
23900
23901 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
23902 @tab No
23903 @tab @samp{-}
23904 @tab Yes
23905
23906 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23907 @tab No
23908 @tab @samp{-}
23909 @tab Yes
23910
23911 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
23912 @tab No
23913 @tab @samp{-}
23914 @tab Yes
23915
23916 @end multitable
23917
23918 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23919
23920 @table @samp
23921 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
23922 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23923 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23924 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23925 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23926 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23927 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23928 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23929 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23930 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23931
23932 @item qXfer:auxv:read
23933 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23934 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23935
23936 @item qXfer:features:read
23937 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
23938 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
23939
23940 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
23941 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
23942 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
23943
23944 @item QPassSignals
23945 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23946 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
23947
23948 @end table
23949
23950 @item qSymbol::
23951 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23952 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23953 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23954 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23955
23956 Reply:
23957 @table @samp
23958 @item OK
23959 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23960 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23961 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23962 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23963 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23964 below.
23965 @end table
23966
23967 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23968 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23969
23970 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23971 target has previously requested.
23972
23973 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23974 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23975 will be empty.
23976
23977 Reply:
23978 @table @samp
23979 @item OK
23980 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23981 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23982 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23983 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23984 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23985 @end table
23986
23987 @item QTDP
23988 @itemx QTFrame
23989 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23990
23991 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23992 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23993 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23994 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23995 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23996 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23997 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23998 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23999 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24000 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24001
24002 Reply:
24003 @table @samp
24004 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24005 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24006 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24007 the thread's attributes.
24008 @end table
24009
24010 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24011 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24012 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24013 packets.)
24014
24015 @item QTStart
24016 @itemx QTStop
24017 @itemx QTinit
24018 @itemx QTro
24019 @itemx qTStatus
24020 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24021
24022 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24023 @cindex read special object, remote request
24024 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24025 @anchor{qXfer read}
24026 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24027 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24028 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24029 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
24030 additional details about what data to access.
24031
24032 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24033 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24034 formats, listed below.
24035
24036 @table @samp
24037 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24038 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24039 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24040 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24041
24042 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24043 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24044
24045 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24046 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24047 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24048 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24049 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24050
24051 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24052 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24053
24054 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24055 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24056 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory map format}. The
24057 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24058 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24059
24060 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24061 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24062 @end table
24063
24064 Reply:
24065 @table @samp
24066 @item m @var{data}
24067 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24068 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24069 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24070 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24071 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24072 request.
24073
24074 @item l @var{data}
24075 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24076 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24077 than the @var{length} in the request.
24078
24079 @item l
24080 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24081 There is no more data to be read.
24082
24083 @item E00
24084 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24085
24086 @item E @var{nn}
24087 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24088 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24089
24090 @item
24091 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24092 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24093 @end table
24094
24095 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24096 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24097 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24098 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24099 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the binary-encoded data
24100 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24101 is specific to the object; it can supply additional details about what data
24102 to access.
24103
24104 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
24105 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
24106 specific request specifications ought to use.
24107
24108 Reply:
24109 @table @samp
24110 @item @var{nn}
24111 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24112 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24113
24114 @item E00
24115 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24116
24117 @item E @var{nn}
24118 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24119 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24120
24121 @item
24122 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24123 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24124 @end table
24125
24126 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24127 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24128 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24129 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24130 must respond with an empty packet.
24131
24132 @end table
24133
24134 @node Register Packet Format
24135 @section Register Packet Format
24136
24137 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24138 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24139 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24140 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24141 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24142 most-significant - least-significant.
24143
24144 @table @r
24145
24146 @item MIPS32
24147
24148 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24149 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24150 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24151
24152 @item MIPS64
24153
24154 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24155 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24156 as @code{MIPS32}.
24157
24158 @end table
24159
24160 @node Tracepoint Packets
24161 @section Tracepoint Packets
24162 @cindex tracepoint packets
24163 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24164
24165 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24166 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24167
24168 @table @samp
24169
24170 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24171 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24172 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24173 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24174 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24175 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24176 tracepoint's actions.
24177
24178 Replies:
24179 @table @samp
24180 @item OK
24181 The packet was understood and carried out.
24182 @item
24183 The packet was not recognized.
24184 @end table
24185
24186 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24187 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24188 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24189 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24190 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24191 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24192 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24193
24194 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24195 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24196 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24197 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24198 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24199 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24200 tracepoint actions.
24201
24202 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24203 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24204 following forms:
24205
24206 @table @samp
24207
24208 @item R @var{mask}
24209 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24210 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24211 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24212 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24213 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24214
24215 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24216 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24217 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24218 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24219 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24220 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24221 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24222
24223 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24224 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24225 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24226 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24227 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24228 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24229 packet).
24230
24231 @end table
24232
24233 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24234 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24235 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24236 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24237 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24238 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24239 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24240 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24241
24242 Replies:
24243 @table @samp
24244 @item OK
24245 The packet was understood and carried out.
24246 @item
24247 The packet was not recognized.
24248 @end table
24249
24250 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24251 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24252 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24253 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24254
24255 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24256 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24257 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24258 one of the following forms:
24259
24260 @table @samp
24261 @item F @var{f}
24262 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24263 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24264 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24265
24266 @item T @var{t}
24267 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24268 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24269
24270 @end table
24271
24272 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24273 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24274 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24275 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24276
24277 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24278 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24279 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24280 is a hexadecimal number.
24281
24282 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24283 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24284 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24285 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24286 numbers.
24287
24288 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24289 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24290 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24291
24292 @item QTStart
24293 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24294 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24295
24296 @item QTStop
24297 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24298
24299 @item QTinit
24300 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24301
24302 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24303 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24304 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24305 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24306
24307 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24308 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24309 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24310 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24311
24312 @item qTStatus
24313 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24314
24315 Replies:
24316 @table @samp
24317 @item T0
24318 There is no trace experiment running.
24319 @item T1
24320 There is a trace experiment running.
24321 @end table
24322
24323 @end table
24324
24325
24326 @node Interrupts
24327 @section Interrupts
24328 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24329
24330 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24331 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24332 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24333 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24334
24335 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24336 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24337 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24338 interfaces.
24339
24340 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24341 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24342 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24343 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24344 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24345 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24346 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24347 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24348
24349 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24350 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24351 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24352 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24353 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24354 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24355 program is stopped will be discarded.
24356
24357 @node Examples
24358 @section Examples
24359
24360 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24361 does not get any direct output:
24362
24363 @smallexample
24364 -> @code{R00}
24365 <- @code{+}
24366 @emph{target restarts}
24367 -> @code{?}
24368 <- @code{+}
24369 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24370 -> @code{+}
24371 @end smallexample
24372
24373 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24374
24375 @smallexample
24376 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24377 <- @code{+}
24378 -> @code{s}
24379 <- @code{+}
24380 @emph{time passes}
24381 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24382 -> @code{+}
24383 -> @code{g}
24384 <- @code{+}
24385 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24386 -> @code{+}
24387 @end smallexample
24388
24389 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
24390 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
24391 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24392
24393 @menu
24394 * File-I/O Overview::
24395 * Protocol basics::
24396 * The F request packet::
24397 * The F reply packet::
24398 * The Ctrl-C message::
24399 * Console I/O::
24400 * List of supported calls::
24401 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
24402 * Constants::
24403 * File-I/O Examples::
24404 @end menu
24405
24406 @node File-I/O Overview
24407 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24408 @cindex file-i/o overview
24409
24410 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24411 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24412 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24413 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24414 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24415 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24416
24417 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24418 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24419 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24420 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24421 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24422
24423 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24424 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24425 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24426 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24427 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24428 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24429 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24430
24431 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24432 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24433 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24434 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24435 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24436
24437 @smallexample
24438 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24439 <- target requests 'system call X'
24440 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24441 -> GDB returns result
24442 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
24443 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24444 @end smallexample
24445
24446 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24447 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24448 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24449 system are not supported by this protocol.
24450
24451 @node Protocol basics
24452 @subsection Protocol basics
24453 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24454
24455 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24456 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24457 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24458 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24459 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24460 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24461 to call the appropriate host system call:
24462
24463 @itemize @bullet
24464 @item
24465 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24466
24467 @item
24468 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24469 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24470 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24471 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol specific representation.
24472
24473 @end itemize
24474
24475 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24476
24477 @itemize @bullet
24478 @item
24479 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24480 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24481 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24482 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24483 packet.
24484
24485 @item
24486 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24487 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24488
24489 @item
24490 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24491
24492 @item
24493 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24494
24495 @item
24496 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24497 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24498 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24499 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24500 packet.
24501
24502 @end itemize
24503
24504 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24505 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24506
24507 @itemize @bullet
24508 @item
24509 Return value.
24510
24511 @item
24512 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24513
24514 @item
24515 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24516
24517 @end itemize
24518
24519 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24520 the latest continue or step action.
24521
24522 @node The F request packet
24523 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
24524 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24525 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24526
24527 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24528
24529 @table @samp
24530 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24531
24532 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24533 This is just the name of the function.
24534
24535 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24536 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24537 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24538 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24539 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24540 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24541 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24542
24543 @end table
24544
24545
24546
24547 @node The F reply packet
24548 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
24549 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24550 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24551
24552 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24553
24554 @table @samp
24555
24556 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call specific attachment}
24557
24558 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24559
24560 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
24561 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24562
24563 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24564 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24565 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24566
24567 @smallexample
24568 F0,0,C
24569 @end smallexample
24570
24571 @noindent
24572 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24573
24574 @smallexample
24575 F-1,4,C
24576 @end smallexample
24577
24578 @noindent
24579 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24580
24581 @end table
24582
24583
24584 @node The Ctrl-C message
24585 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} message
24586 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24587
24588 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24589 reply packet (@pxref{The F reply packet}),
24590 the target should behave as if it had
24591 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24592 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24593 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24594 packet.
24595
24596 It's important for the target to know in which
24597 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24598
24599 @itemize @bullet
24600 @item
24601 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24602
24603 @item
24604 The system call on the host has been finished.
24605
24606 @end itemize
24607
24608 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24609 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24610 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24611 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24612 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24613 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24614
24615 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24616 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24617 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24618 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24619 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24620 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24621 or the full action has been completed.
24622
24623 @node Console I/O
24624 @subsection Console I/O
24625 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24626
24627 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
24628 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24629 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24630 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24631 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24632 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24633 conditions is met:
24634
24635 @itemize @bullet
24636 @item
24637 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24638 @code{read}
24639 system call is treated as finished.
24640
24641 @item
24642 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24643 newline.
24644
24645 @item
24646 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24647 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24648
24649 @end itemize
24650
24651 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24652 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24653 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24654 is stopped at the user's request.
24655
24656
24657 @node List of supported calls
24658 @subsection List of supported calls
24659 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24660
24661 @menu
24662 * open::
24663 * close::
24664 * read::
24665 * write::
24666 * lseek::
24667 * rename::
24668 * unlink::
24669 * stat/fstat::
24670 * gettimeofday::
24671 * isatty::
24672 * system::
24673 @end menu
24674
24675 @node open
24676 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24677 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24678
24679 @table @asis
24680 @item Synopsis:
24681 @smallexample
24682 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24683 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24684 @end smallexample
24685
24686 @item Request:
24687 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24688
24689 @noindent
24690 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24691
24692 @table @code
24693 @item O_CREAT
24694 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24695 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24696 are concerned.
24697
24698 @item O_EXCL
24699 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24700 an error and open() fails.
24701
24702 @item O_TRUNC
24703 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24704 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24705 truncated to zero length.
24706
24707 @item O_APPEND
24708 The file is opened in append mode.
24709
24710 @item O_RDONLY
24711 The file is opened for reading only.
24712
24713 @item O_WRONLY
24714 The file is opened for writing only.
24715
24716 @item O_RDWR
24717 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24718 @end table
24719
24720 @noindent
24721 Other bits are silently ignored.
24722
24723
24724 @noindent
24725 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24726
24727 @table @code
24728 @item S_IRUSR
24729 User has read permission.
24730
24731 @item S_IWUSR
24732 User has write permission.
24733
24734 @item S_IRGRP
24735 Group has read permission.
24736
24737 @item S_IWGRP
24738 Group has write permission.
24739
24740 @item S_IROTH
24741 Others have read permission.
24742
24743 @item S_IWOTH
24744 Others have write permission.
24745 @end table
24746
24747 @noindent
24748 Other bits are silently ignored.
24749
24750
24751 @item Return value:
24752 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24753 occurred.
24754
24755 @item Errors:
24756
24757 @table @code
24758 @item EEXIST
24759 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24760
24761 @item EISDIR
24762 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24763
24764 @item EACCES
24765 The requested access is not allowed.
24766
24767 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24768 @var{pathname} was too long.
24769
24770 @item ENOENT
24771 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24772
24773 @item ENODEV
24774 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24775
24776 @item EROFS
24777 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24778 write access was requested.
24779
24780 @item EFAULT
24781 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24782
24783 @item ENOSPC
24784 No space on device to create the file.
24785
24786 @item EMFILE
24787 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24788
24789 @item ENFILE
24790 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24791 has been reached.
24792
24793 @item EINTR
24794 The call was interrupted by the user.
24795 @end table
24796
24797 @end table
24798
24799 @node close
24800 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24801 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24802
24803 @table @asis
24804 @item Synopsis:
24805 @smallexample
24806 int close(int fd);
24807 @end smallexample
24808
24809 @item Request:
24810 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24811
24812 @item Return value:
24813 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24814
24815 @item Errors:
24816
24817 @table @code
24818 @item EBADF
24819 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24820
24821 @item EINTR
24822 The call was interrupted by the user.
24823 @end table
24824
24825 @end table
24826
24827 @node read
24828 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24829 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24830
24831 @table @asis
24832 @item Synopsis:
24833 @smallexample
24834 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24835 @end smallexample
24836
24837 @item Request:
24838 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24839
24840 @item Return value:
24841 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24842 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24843 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24844
24845 @item Errors:
24846
24847 @table @code
24848 @item EBADF
24849 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24850 reading.
24851
24852 @item EFAULT
24853 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24854
24855 @item EINTR
24856 The call was interrupted by the user.
24857 @end table
24858
24859 @end table
24860
24861 @node write
24862 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24863 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24864
24865 @table @asis
24866 @item Synopsis:
24867 @smallexample
24868 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24869 @end smallexample
24870
24871 @item Request:
24872 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24873
24874 @item Return value:
24875 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24876 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24877 is returned.
24878
24879 @item Errors:
24880
24881 @table @code
24882 @item EBADF
24883 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24884 writing.
24885
24886 @item EFAULT
24887 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24888
24889 @item EFBIG
24890 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24891 host specific maximum file size allowed.
24892
24893 @item ENOSPC
24894 No space on device to write the data.
24895
24896 @item EINTR
24897 The call was interrupted by the user.
24898 @end table
24899
24900 @end table
24901
24902 @node lseek
24903 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24904 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24905
24906 @table @asis
24907 @item Synopsis:
24908 @smallexample
24909 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24910 @end smallexample
24911
24912 @item Request:
24913 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24914
24915 @var{flag} is one of:
24916
24917 @table @code
24918 @item SEEK_SET
24919 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24920
24921 @item SEEK_CUR
24922 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24923 bytes.
24924
24925 @item SEEK_END
24926 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24927 bytes.
24928 @end table
24929
24930 @item Return value:
24931 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24932 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24933 value of -1 is returned.
24934
24935 @item Errors:
24936
24937 @table @code
24938 @item EBADF
24939 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24940
24941 @item ESPIPE
24942 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24943
24944 @item EINVAL
24945 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
24946
24947 @item EINTR
24948 The call was interrupted by the user.
24949 @end table
24950
24951 @end table
24952
24953 @node rename
24954 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24955 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24956
24957 @table @asis
24958 @item Synopsis:
24959 @smallexample
24960 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24961 @end smallexample
24962
24963 @item Request:
24964 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24965
24966 @item Return value:
24967 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24968
24969 @item Errors:
24970
24971 @table @code
24972 @item EISDIR
24973 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24974 directory.
24975
24976 @item EEXIST
24977 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24978
24979 @item EBUSY
24980 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24981 process.
24982
24983 @item EINVAL
24984 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24985 of itself.
24986
24987 @item ENOTDIR
24988 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24989 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24990 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24991
24992 @item EFAULT
24993 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24994
24995 @item EACCES
24996 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24997
24998 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24999
25000 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25001
25002 @item ENOENT
25003 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25004
25005 @item EROFS
25006 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25007
25008 @item ENOSPC
25009 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25010 directory entry.
25011
25012 @item EINTR
25013 The call was interrupted by the user.
25014 @end table
25015
25016 @end table
25017
25018 @node unlink
25019 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25020 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25021
25022 @table @asis
25023 @item Synopsis:
25024 @smallexample
25025 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25026 @end smallexample
25027
25028 @item Request:
25029 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25030
25031 @item Return value:
25032 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25033
25034 @item Errors:
25035
25036 @table @code
25037 @item EACCES
25038 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25039
25040 @item EPERM
25041 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25042
25043 @item EBUSY
25044 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25045 being used by another process.
25046
25047 @item EFAULT
25048 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25049
25050 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25051 @var{pathname} was too long.
25052
25053 @item ENOENT
25054 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25055
25056 @item ENOTDIR
25057 A component of the path is not a directory.
25058
25059 @item EROFS
25060 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25061
25062 @item EINTR
25063 The call was interrupted by the user.
25064 @end table
25065
25066 @end table
25067
25068 @node stat/fstat
25069 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25070 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25071 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25072
25073 @table @asis
25074 @item Synopsis:
25075 @smallexample
25076 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25077 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25078 @end smallexample
25079
25080 @item Request:
25081 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25082 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25083
25084 @item Return value:
25085 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25086
25087 @item Errors:
25088
25089 @table @code
25090 @item EBADF
25091 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25092
25093 @item ENOENT
25094 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25095 path is an empty string.
25096
25097 @item ENOTDIR
25098 A component of the path is not a directory.
25099
25100 @item EFAULT
25101 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25102
25103 @item EACCES
25104 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25105
25106 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25107 @var{pathname} was too long.
25108
25109 @item EINTR
25110 The call was interrupted by the user.
25111 @end table
25112
25113 @end table
25114
25115 @node gettimeofday
25116 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25117 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25118
25119 @table @asis
25120 @item Synopsis:
25121 @smallexample
25122 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25123 @end smallexample
25124
25125 @item Request:
25126 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25127
25128 @item Return value:
25129 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25130
25131 @item Errors:
25132
25133 @table @code
25134 @item EINVAL
25135 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25136
25137 @item EFAULT
25138 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25139 @end table
25140
25141 @end table
25142
25143 @node isatty
25144 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25145 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25146
25147 @table @asis
25148 @item Synopsis:
25149 @smallexample
25150 int isatty(int fd);
25151 @end smallexample
25152
25153 @item Request:
25154 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25155
25156 @item Return value:
25157 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25158
25159 @item Errors:
25160
25161 @table @code
25162 @item EINTR
25163 The call was interrupted by the user.
25164 @end table
25165
25166 @end table
25167
25168 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25169 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25170 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25171 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25172 needed.
25173
25174
25175 @node system
25176 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25177 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25178
25179 @table @asis
25180 @item Synopsis:
25181 @smallexample
25182 int system(const char *command);
25183 @end smallexample
25184
25185 @item Request:
25186 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25187
25188 @item Return value:
25189 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25190 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25191 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25192 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25193 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25194 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25195 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25196
25197 @item Errors:
25198
25199 @table @code
25200 @item EINTR
25201 The call was interrupted by the user.
25202 @end table
25203
25204 @end table
25205
25206 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25207 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25208 the host is simplified before it's returned
25209 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25210 is discarded, and the return value consists
25211 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25212
25213 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25214 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25215 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25216
25217 @table @code
25218 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25219 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25220 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25221 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25222
25223 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25224 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25225 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25226 protocol.
25227 @end table
25228
25229 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25230 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25231 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25232
25233 @menu
25234 * Integral datatypes::
25235 * Pointer values::
25236 * Memory transfer::
25237 * struct stat::
25238 * struct timeval::
25239 @end menu
25240
25241 @node Integral datatypes
25242 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
25243 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25244
25245 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25246 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25247 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25248
25249 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25250 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25251
25252 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25253
25254 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25255 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25256
25257 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25258
25259 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25260 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25261 byte order.
25262
25263 @node Pointer values
25264 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
25265 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25266
25267 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25268 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25269 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25270 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25271
25272 @smallexample
25273 @code{1aaf/12}
25274 @end smallexample
25275
25276 @noindent
25277 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25278 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25279 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25280 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25281
25282 @smallexample
25283 @code{123456/d}
25284 @end smallexample
25285
25286 @node Memory transfer
25287 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory transfer
25288 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25289
25290 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25291 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol specific format
25292 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25293 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25294 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25295 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25296 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25297
25298
25299 @node struct stat
25300 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25301 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25302
25303 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25304 is defined as follows:
25305
25306 @smallexample
25307 struct stat @{
25308 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25309 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25310 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25311 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25312 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25313 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25314 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25315 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25316 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25317 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25318 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25319 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25320 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25321 @};
25322 @end smallexample
25323
25324 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25325 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25326 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25327
25328 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25329 range of values.
25330
25331 @table @code
25332
25333 @item st_dev
25334 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25335
25336 @item st_ino
25337 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25338
25339 @item st_mode
25340 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25341 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25342
25343 @item st_uid
25344 @itemx st_gid
25345 @itemx st_rdev
25346 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25347
25348 @item st_atime
25349 @itemx st_mtime
25350 @itemx st_ctime
25351 These values have a host and file system dependent
25352 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25353 support exact timing values.
25354 @end table
25355
25356 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25357 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25358 continuing.
25359
25360 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25361 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25362 get truncated on the target.
25363
25364 @node struct timeval
25365 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25366 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25367
25368 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25369 is defined as follows:
25370
25371 @smallexample
25372 struct timeval @{
25373 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25374 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25375 @};
25376 @end smallexample
25377
25378 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25379 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25380 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25381
25382 @node Constants
25383 @subsection Constants
25384 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25385
25386 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25387 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25388 values before and after the call as needed.
25389
25390 @menu
25391 * Open flags::
25392 * mode_t values::
25393 * Errno values::
25394 * Lseek flags::
25395 * Limits::
25396 @end menu
25397
25398 @node Open flags
25399 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
25400 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25401
25402 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25403
25404 @smallexample
25405 O_RDONLY 0x0
25406 O_WRONLY 0x1
25407 O_RDWR 0x2
25408 O_APPEND 0x8
25409 O_CREAT 0x200
25410 O_TRUNC 0x400
25411 O_EXCL 0x800
25412 @end smallexample
25413
25414 @node mode_t values
25415 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
25416 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25417
25418 All values are given in octal representation.
25419
25420 @smallexample
25421 S_IFREG 0100000
25422 S_IFDIR 040000
25423 S_IRUSR 0400
25424 S_IWUSR 0200
25425 S_IXUSR 0100
25426 S_IRGRP 040
25427 S_IWGRP 020
25428 S_IXGRP 010
25429 S_IROTH 04
25430 S_IWOTH 02
25431 S_IXOTH 01
25432 @end smallexample
25433
25434 @node Errno values
25435 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
25436 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25437
25438 All values are given in decimal representation.
25439
25440 @smallexample
25441 EPERM 1
25442 ENOENT 2
25443 EINTR 4
25444 EBADF 9
25445 EACCES 13
25446 EFAULT 14
25447 EBUSY 16
25448 EEXIST 17
25449 ENODEV 19
25450 ENOTDIR 20
25451 EISDIR 21
25452 EINVAL 22
25453 ENFILE 23
25454 EMFILE 24
25455 EFBIG 27
25456 ENOSPC 28
25457 ESPIPE 29
25458 EROFS 30
25459 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25460 EUNKNOWN 9999
25461 @end smallexample
25462
25463 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25464 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25465
25466 @node Lseek flags
25467 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
25468 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25469
25470 @smallexample
25471 SEEK_SET 0
25472 SEEK_CUR 1
25473 SEEK_END 2
25474 @end smallexample
25475
25476 @node Limits
25477 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25478 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25479
25480 All values are given in decimal representation.
25481
25482 @smallexample
25483 INT_MIN -2147483648
25484 INT_MAX 2147483647
25485 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25486 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25487 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25488 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25489 @end smallexample
25490
25491 @node File-I/O Examples
25492 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25493 @cindex file-i/o examples
25494
25495 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25496 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25497
25498 @smallexample
25499 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25500 @emph{request memory read from target}
25501 -> @code{m1234,6}
25502 <- XXXXXX
25503 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25504 -> @code{F6}
25505 @end smallexample
25506
25507 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25508 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25509
25510 @smallexample
25511 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25512 @emph{request memory write to target}
25513 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25514 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25515 -> @code{F6}
25516 @end smallexample
25517
25518 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25519 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25520
25521 @smallexample
25522 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25523 -> @code{F-1,9}
25524 @end smallexample
25525
25526 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25527 host is called:
25528
25529 @smallexample
25530 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25531 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25532 <- @code{T02}
25533 @end smallexample
25534
25535 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25536 host is called:
25537
25538 @smallexample
25539 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25540 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25541 <- @code{T02}
25542 @end smallexample
25543
25544 @node Memory map format
25545 @section Memory map format
25546 @cindex memory map format
25547
25548 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25549 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25550 memory map.
25551
25552 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25553 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25554 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25555
25556 @smallexample
25557 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25558 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25559 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25560 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25561 <memory-map>
25562 region...
25563 </memory-map>
25564 @end smallexample
25565
25566 Each region can be either:
25567
25568 @itemize
25569
25570 @item
25571 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25572 bytes from there:
25573
25574 @smallexample
25575 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25576 @end smallexample
25577
25578
25579 @item
25580 A region of read-only memory:
25581
25582 @smallexample
25583 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25584 @end smallexample
25585
25586
25587 @item
25588 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25589 bytes in length:
25590
25591 @smallexample
25592 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25593 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25594 </memory>
25595 @end smallexample
25596
25597 @end itemize
25598
25599 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25600 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25601 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25602
25603 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25604
25605 @smallexample
25606 <!-- ................................................... -->
25607 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25608 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25609 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25610 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25611 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25612 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25613 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25614 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25615 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25616 and its type, or device. -->
25617 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25618 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25619 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25620 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25621 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25622 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25623 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25624 @end smallexample
25625
25626 @include agentexpr.texi
25627
25628 @node Target Descriptions
25629 @appendix Target Descriptions
25630 @cindex target descriptions
25631
25632 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
25633 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
25634 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
25635
25636 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
25637 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
25638 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
25639 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
25640 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
25641 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
25642 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
25643
25644 @itemize @bullet
25645 @item
25646 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
25647 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
25648 @item
25649 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
25650 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
25651 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
25652 @item
25653 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
25654 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
25655 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
25656 @end itemize
25657
25658 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
25659 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
25660 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
25661 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
25662 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
25663
25664 @menu
25665 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
25666 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
25667 @end menu
25668
25669 @node Retrieving Descriptions
25670 @section Retrieving Descriptions
25671
25672 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
25673 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
25674 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
25675 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
25676 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
25677 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
25678 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
25679 Format}.
25680
25681 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
25682 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
25683 specify a file are:
25684
25685 @table @code
25686 @cindex set tdesc filename
25687 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
25688 Read the target description from @var{path}.
25689
25690 @cindex unset tdesc filename
25691 @item unset tdesc filename
25692 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
25693 will use the description supplied by the current target.
25694
25695 @cindex show tdesc filename
25696 @item show tdesc filename
25697 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
25698 @end table
25699
25700
25701 @node Target Description Format
25702 @section Target Description Format
25703 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
25704
25705 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
25706 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
25707 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
25708 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
25709 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
25710 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
25711 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
25712
25713 At the moment, target descriptions can only provide minimal information
25714 about the architecture of the remote target. @value{GDBN} can use this
25715 information to autoconfigure, or to warn you if you connect to an
25716 unsupported target.
25717
25718 Here is a simple target description:
25719
25720 @example
25721 <target>
25722 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
25723 </target>
25724 @end example
25725
25726 @noindent
25727 This minimal description only says that the target uses
25728 the x86-64 architecture.
25729
25730 A target description has the overall form:
25731
25732 @example
25733 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25734 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
25735 <target>
25736 <architecture>@var{arch name}</architecture>
25737 </target>
25738 @end example
25739
25740 @noindent
25741 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
25742 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
25743 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
25744 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
25745 useful for XML validation tools.
25746
25747 The content of the @samp{<architecture>} element is an architecture
25748 name, from the same selection accepted by @code{set architecture}
25749 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25750
25751
25752 @include gpl.texi
25753
25754 @raisesections
25755 @include fdl.texi
25756 @lowersections
25757
25758 @node Index
25759 @unnumbered Index
25760
25761 @printindex cp
25762
25763 @tex
25764 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
25765 % meantime:
25766 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
25767 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
25768 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
25769 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
25770 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
25771 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
25772 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
25773 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
25774 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
25775 \page\colophon
25776 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
25777 @end tex
25778
25779 @bye
This page took 0.566951 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.